]> gcc.gnu.org Git - gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/tm.texi.in
Avoid memory overrun in a test leading to potential double-free.
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi.in
CommitLineData
38f8b050
JR
1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@node Target Macros
8@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9@cindex machine description macros
10@cindex target description macros
11@cindex macros, target description
12@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28@menu
29* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37* Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59* Misc:: Everything else.
60@end menu
61
62@node Target Structure
63@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64@cindex target hooks
65@cindex target functions
66
67@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75@smallexample
76#include "target.h"
77#include "target-def.h"
78
79/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85@end smallexample
86@end deftypevar
87
88Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92@code{targetm} structure.
93
acce4e77
JM
94Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
95specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
96Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
97the initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
98@file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
99themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
100@file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
101
38f8b050
JR
102@node Driver
103@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
104@cindex driver
105@cindex controlling the compilation driver
106
107@c prevent bad page break with this line
108You can control the compilation driver.
109
38f8b050
JR
110@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
111A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
112initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
113
114The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
115default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
116choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
117applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
118options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
119using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
120
121This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
122options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
123that the other specs are easier to write.
124
125Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
126@end defmac
127
128@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
129A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
130@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
131for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
132outermost pair of surrounding braces.
133
134The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
135the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
136to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
137@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
138everywhere it occurs.
139
140The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
141default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
142the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
143
144Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
145@end defmac
146
147@defmac CPP_SPEC
148A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
149pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
150give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
151
152Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
153@end defmac
154
155@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
156This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
157than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
158@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
159@end defmac
160
161@defmac CC1_SPEC
162A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
163pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
164front ends.
165It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
166for GCC to pass to front ends.
167
168Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
169@end defmac
170
171@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
172A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
173pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
174give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
175
176Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
177Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
178@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
179CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
180@end defmac
181
182@defmac ASM_SPEC
183A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
184pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
185you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
186See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
187
188Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
189@end defmac
190
191@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
192A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
193run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
194Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
195an example of this.
196
197Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
198@end defmac
199
200@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
201Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
202an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
203read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
204output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
205@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
206
207If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
208standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
209cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
210see @file{mips.h} for instance.
211@end defmac
212
213@defmac LINK_SPEC
214A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
215pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
216give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
217
218Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
219@end defmac
220
221@defmac LIB_SPEC
222Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
223between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
224command given to the linker.
225
226If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
227loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
228@end defmac
229
230@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
231Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
232how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
233linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
234the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
235
236If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
237passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
238@end defmac
239
240@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
241By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
242@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
243instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
244depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
245@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
246targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
247@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
248driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
249line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
250@end defmac
251
252@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
253A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
254mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
255generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
256static exception handler library, when linking without any of
257@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
258@end defmac
259
260@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
261If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
262When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
263the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
264@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
265@end defmac
266
267@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
268Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
269difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
270the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
271
272If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
273standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
274@end defmac
275
276@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
277Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
278difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
279the very end of the command given to the linker.
280
281Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
282@end defmac
283
284@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
285GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
286However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
287models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
288@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
289blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
290default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
291@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
292@end defmac
293
294@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
295Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
296configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
297et al, within sysroot+suffix.
298@end defmac
299
300@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
301Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
302GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
303updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
304usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
305@end defmac
306
307@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
308Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
309@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
310@code{CC1_SPEC}.
311
312The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
313containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
314string constant that provides the specification.
315
316Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
317
318@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
319related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
320to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
321these definitions.
322
323For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
324define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
325used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
326used.
327
328The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
329
330@smallexample
331#define EXTRA_SPECS \
332 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
333
334#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
335@end smallexample
336
337The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
338@smallexample
339#undef CPP_SPEC
340#define CPP_SPEC \
341"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
342%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
343%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
344%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
345
346#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
347#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
348@end smallexample
349
350while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
351@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
352
353@smallexample
354#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
355#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
356@end smallexample
357@end defmac
358
359@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
360Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
361@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
362the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
363@end defmac
364
365@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
366The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
367By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
368@end defmac
369
370@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
371A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
372linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
373change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
374define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
375line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
376the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
377@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
378@end defmac
379
380@defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
381A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
382directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
383removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
384@end defmac
385
386@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
387Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
388string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
389target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
390@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
391
392Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
393the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
394@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
395@xref{Target Fragment}.
396@end defmac
397
398@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
399Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
400a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
401indicates an absolute file name.
402@end defmac
403
404@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
405If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
406@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
407when the compiler is built as a cross
408compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
409to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
410@end defmac
411
412@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
413Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
414standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
415try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
416@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
417is built as a cross compiler.
418@end defmac
419
420@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
421Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
422standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
423when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
424@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
425is built as a cross compiler.
426@end defmac
427
428@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
429Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
430standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
431default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
432@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
433is built as a cross compiler.
434@end defmac
435
436@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
437If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
438standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
439compiler is built as a cross compiler.
440@end defmac
441
442@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
443If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
444standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
445cross compiler.
446@end defmac
447
448@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
449Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
450variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
451loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
452initialize the necessary environment variables.
453@end defmac
454
455@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
456Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
457standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
458try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
459comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
460
461Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
462replacement.
463@end defmac
464
465@defmac SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
466Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
467system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
468directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
469@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
470
471Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
472specified.
473@end defmac
474
475@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
476Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
477standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
478try when searching for header files.
479
480Cross compilers ignore this macro and do not search either
481@file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
482@end defmac
483
484@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
485The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
486See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
487If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
488@end defmac
489
490@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
491Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
492for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
493usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
494@code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
495@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
496and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
497and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
498@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
499
500The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
501Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
502string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
503for C++-only directories,
504and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
505wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
506the array with a null element.
507
508The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
509if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
510or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
511operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
512
513For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
514
515@smallexample
516#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
517@{ \
518 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
519 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
520 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
521 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
522 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
523@}
524@end smallexample
525@end defmac
526
527Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
528
529@enumerate
530@item
531Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
532
533@item
534The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
535is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
536@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
537
538@item
539The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
540
541@item
542The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
543in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
544
545@item
546The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
547
548@item
549The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
550
551@item
552The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
553compiler.
554@end enumerate
555
556Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
557
558@enumerate
559@item
560Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
561
562@item
563The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
564value based on the installed toolchain location.
565
566@item
567The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
568(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
569
570@item
571The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
572in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
573
574@item
575The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
576
577@item
578The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
579compiler.
580
581@item
582The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
583native compiler, or we have a target system root.
584
585@item
586The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
587native compiler, or we have a target system root.
588
589@item
590The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
591If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
592the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
593
594@item
595The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
596compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
597@file{/lib/}.
598
599@item
600The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
601compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
602@file{/usr/lib/}.
603@end enumerate
604
605@node Run-time Target
606@section Run-time Target Specification
607@cindex run-time target specification
608@cindex predefined macros
609@cindex target specifications
610
611@c prevent bad page break with this line
612Here are run-time target specifications.
613
614@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
615This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
616built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
617the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
618@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
619calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
620finished command line option processing your code can use those
621results freely.
622
623@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
624command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
625the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
626accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
627
628@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
629object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
630@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
631defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
632with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
633only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
634example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
635and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
636@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
637defines only @code{_ABI64}.
638
639You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
640@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
641or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
642assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
643macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
644to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
645variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
646@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
647preprocessing.
648@end defmac
649
650@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
651Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
652and is used for the target operating system instead.
653@end defmac
654
655@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
656Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
657and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
658macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
659it yourself.
660@end defmac
661
662@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
663This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
664any target-specific headers.
665@end deftypevar
666
667@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
668This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
669Its default setting is 0.
670@end deftypevr
671
672@cindex optional hardware or system features
673@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
674
675@hook TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
676This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
677target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
678(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
679processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
680definition does nothing but return true.
681
96e45421
JM
682@var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
683@var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
684storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
685option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
686via attributes).
38f8b050
JR
687@end deftypefn
688
689@hook TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION
690This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
691target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
692definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
693option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
694valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
695default definition does nothing but return false.
696
697In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
698options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
699only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
700should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
701@end deftypefn
702
91ebb981
IS
703@hook TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT
704
705@hook TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P
706
707@hook TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG
26705988 708
38f8b050
JR
709@hook TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE
710This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
711but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
712pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
713attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
714when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
715actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
716@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
717@end deftypefn
718
719@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
c5387660
JM
720This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
721but is only used in the C
38f8b050
JR
722language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
723used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
724frontends.
725@end defmac
726
3020190e 727@hook TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
38f8b050 728Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
3020190e
JM
729various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
730options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
731options are processed once
38f8b050 732just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
3020190e 733of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
2b0d3573 734options passed explicitly.
38f8b050 735
3020190e 736This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
38f8b050
JR
737options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
738@code{optimize} attribute.
3020190e 739@end deftypevr
38f8b050 740
7e4aae92
JM
741@hook TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT
742
128dc8e2
JM
743@hook TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS
744
38f8b050
JR
745@hook TARGET_HELP
746This hook is called in response to the user invoking
747@option{--target-help} on the command line. It gives the target a
748chance to display extra information on the target specific command
749line options found in its @file{.opt} file.
750@end deftypefn
751
3bd36029
RS
752@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
753Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
754during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
755the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
756can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
757and @code{nomips16} attributes.
758
759Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
760registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
761operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
762in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
763significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
764for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
765switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
766
767Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
768is 0.
769@end defmac
770
38f8b050
JR
771@node Per-Function Data
772@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
773@cindex per-function data
774@cindex data structures
775
776If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
777provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
778using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
779nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
780when another one comes along.
781
782GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
783contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
784structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
785@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
786to their own specific data.
787
788If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
789@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
790This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
791@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
792
793One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
794RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
795RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
796function, for level 0.
797
798Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
799all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
800function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
801stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
802stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
803@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
804the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
805single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
806longer supported.
807
808@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
809Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
810is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
811The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
812function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
813@end defmac
814
815@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
816If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
817function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
818target to perform any target specific initialization of the
819@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
820used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
821
822@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
823Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
824GC allocation, including the structure itself.
825@end deftypevar
826
827@node Storage Layout
828@section Storage Layout
829@cindex storage layout
830
831Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
832alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
833expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
834@xref{Run-time Target}.
835
836@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
837Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
838byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
839This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
840bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
841be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
842macro need not be a constant.
843
844This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
845bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
846@end defmac
847
848@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
849Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
850word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
851@end defmac
852
853@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
854Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
855most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
856memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
857order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
858macro need not be a constant.
859@end defmac
860
38f8b050
JR
861@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
862Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
863@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
864containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
865have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
866
867You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
868multi-word integers.
869@end defmac
870
871@defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
872Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
873unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
874@end defmac
875
876@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
877Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
878is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
879@end defmac
880
881@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
882Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
883@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
884largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
885@end defmac
886
887@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
888Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
889register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
890@end defmac
891
892@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
893Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
894@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
895smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
896@end defmac
897
38f8b050
JR
898@defmac POINTER_SIZE
899Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
900width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
901you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
902a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
903@end defmac
904
905@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
906A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
907@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
908greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
909should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
910is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
911@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
912
913You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
914and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
915@end defmac
916
917@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
918A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
919is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
920stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
921scalar type.
922
923On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
924register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
925@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
926cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
927floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
928counterparts.
929
930For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
931However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
932either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
933the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
934sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
935@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
936
937Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
938@end defmac
939
940@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
941Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
942function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
943and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
944change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
945pointer} types.
946
947@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
948return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
949@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
950If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
951which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
952then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
953the signedness may be different.
954
955The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
956also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
957if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
958@end deftypefn
959
960@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
961Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
962bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
963regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
964size of an integer.
965@end defmac
966
967@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
968Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
969stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
970desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
971if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
972this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
973@end defmac
974
975@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
976Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
977stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
978is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
979macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
980@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
981@end defmac
982
983@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
984Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
985from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
986to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
987@end defmac
988
989@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
990Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
991@end defmac
992
993@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
994Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
995bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
996just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
997@end defmac
998
999@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1000Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1001provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1002@end defmac
1003
1004@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1005Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1006not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1007@end defmac
1008
1009@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1010If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1011object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1012nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1013on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1014@end defmac
1015
1016@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1017Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1018machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1019structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1020by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1021@end defmac
1022
1023@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1024An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1025alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1026@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1027alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1028field alignment has not been set by the
1029@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1030@end defmac
1031
1032@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1033Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1034to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1035
1036If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1037
1038@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1039@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1040@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1041@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1042@end defmac
1043
1044@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1045Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1046Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1047@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1048the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1049
1050On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1051the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1052a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1053On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1054@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1055@end defmac
1056
1057@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1058If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1059the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1060the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1061macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1062
1063If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1064
1065@findex strcpy
1066One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1067make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1068arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1069constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1070@end defmac
1071
1072@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1073If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1074that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1075@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1076have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1077align the object.
1078
1079If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1080
1081The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1082constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1083constants can be done inline.
1084@end defmac
1085
1086@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1087If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1088the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1089the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1090macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1091
1092If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1093
1094One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1095make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1096
64ad7c99 1097If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1098@end defmac
1099
1100@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1101If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1102@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1103and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1104have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1105align the slot.
1106
1107If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1108@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1109be used.
1110
1111This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1112of all possible modes which the slot may have.
4a6336ad 1113
64ad7c99 1114If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1115@end defmac
1116
1117@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1118If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1119variable @var{decl}.
1120
1121If this macro is not defined, then
1122@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1123is used.
1124
1125One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1126make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1127
64ad7c99 1128If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1129@end defmac
1130
1131@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1132If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1133for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1134@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1135
1136If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1137@end defmac
1138
1139@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1140Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1141empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1142
1143If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1144@end defmac
1145
1146@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1147Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1148Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1149
1150If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1151@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1152@end defmac
1153
1154@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1155Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1156if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1157go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1158@end defmac
1159
1160@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1161Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1162alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1163
1164The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1165@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1166structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1167that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1168that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1169
1170Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1171@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1172four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1173not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1174
1175An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1176structure.
1177
1178If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1179a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1180
1181Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1182bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1183support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1184@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1185
1186The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1187@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1188Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1189
1190Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1191@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1192@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1193
1194If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1195bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1196what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1197
1198@smallexample
1199struct foo1
1200@{
1201 char x;
1202 char :0;
1203 char y;
1204@};
1205
1206struct foo2
1207@{
1208 char x;
1209 int :0;
1210 char y;
1211@};
1212
1213main ()
1214@{
1215 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1216 sizeof (struct foo1));
1217 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1218 sizeof (struct foo2));
1219 exit (0);
1220@}
1221@end smallexample
1222
1223If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1224get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1225@end defmac
1226
1227@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1228Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1229to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1230@end defmac
1231
1232@hook TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
1233When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1234whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1235structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1236the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1237@end deftypefn
1238
1239@hook TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
1240This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1241should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1242these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1243
1244The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1245@end deftypefn
1246
1247@defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1248Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1249@code{BLKMODE}.
1250
1251If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1252mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1253case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1254retain the field's mode.
1255
1256Normally, this is not needed.
1257@end defmac
1258
1259@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1260Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1261by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1262way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1263@var{specified}.
1264
1265The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1266the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1267@end defmac
1268
1269@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1270An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1271machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1272this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1273appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1274(DImode)} is assumed.
1275@end defmac
1276
1277@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1278If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1279specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1280@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1281@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1282@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1283having its mode specified.
1284
1285You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1286would most commonly define this macro if the
1287@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
128864-bit mode.
1289@end defmac
1290
1291@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1292If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1293specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1294@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1295
1296You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1297You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1298pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1299@end defmac
1300
1301@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE
1302This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1303of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1304@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1305targets.
1306@end deftypefn
1307
1308@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE
1309This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1310of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1311@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1312targets.
1313@end deftypefn
1314
1315@hook TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE
1316Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1317The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1318@end deftypefn
1319
1320@defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1321If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1322mode is towards zero.
1323
1324Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1325floating-point arithmetic.
1326
1327Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1328@end defmac
1329
1330@defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1331This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1332bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1333exponent for normal numbers instead.
1334
1335Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1336floating-point arithmetic.
1337
1338The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1339@end defmac
1340
1341@hook TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P
1342This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1343@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1344Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1345unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1346different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1347alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1348bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1349the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1350(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1351another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1352other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1353
1354When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1355of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1356bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1357and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1358chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1359size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1360alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1361
1362If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1363the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1364used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1365precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1366may affect its placement.
1367@end deftypefn
1368
1369@hook TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P
1370Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1371@end deftypefn
1372
1373@hook TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P
1374Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1375@end deftypefn
1376
1377@hook TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK
1378This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1379to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1380For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1381for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1382registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1383usage.
1384@end deftypefn
1385
1386@hook TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
1387This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1388that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1389@end deftypefn
1390
1391@hook TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
1392If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1393uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1394to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1395mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1396the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1397not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1398for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1399return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1400string constant.
1401
1402Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1403qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1404fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1405is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1406length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1407ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1408@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1409@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1410code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1411@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1412codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1413spaces in your string.
1414
1415This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1416name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1417can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1418before mangling.
1419
1420The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1421appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1422types.
1423@end deftypefn
1424
1425@node Type Layout
1426@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1427
1428These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1429basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1430the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1431languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1432
1433@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1434A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1435target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1436@end defmac
1437
1438@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1439A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1440target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1441(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1442unit.)
1443@end defmac
1444
1445@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1446A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1447target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1448@end defmac
1449
1450@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1451On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1452@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1453that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1454the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1455value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1456@end defmac
1457
1458@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1459A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1460target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1461words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1462macro must be at least 64.
1463@end defmac
1464
1465@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1466A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1467target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1468@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1469@end defmac
1470
1471@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1472A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1473C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1474this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1475@end defmac
1476
1477@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1478A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1479target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1480@end defmac
1481
1482@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1483A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1484target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1485words.
1486@end defmac
1487
1488@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1489A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1490the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1491words.
1492@end defmac
1493
1494@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1495A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1496the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1497@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1498@end defmac
1499
1500@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1501A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1502the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1503@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1504@end defmac
1505
1506@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1507A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1508the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1509@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1510@end defmac
1511
1512@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1513A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1514the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1515@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1516@end defmac
1517
1518@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1519A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1520the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1521@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1522@end defmac
1523
1524@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1525A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1526the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1527@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1528@end defmac
1529
1530@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1531A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1532the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1533@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1534@end defmac
1535
1536@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1537A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1538the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1539@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1540@end defmac
1541
1542@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1543Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1544if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1545@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1546default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1547@end defmac
1548
1549@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
a18bdccd 1550Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
38f8b050
JR
1551@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1552@code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
a18bdccd 1553anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
38f8b050
JR
1554or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1555otherwise it is 0.
1556@end defmac
1557
1558@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1559Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1560@code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1561anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1562is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1563@end defmac
1564
1565@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1566Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1567@code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1568anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1569is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1570@end defmac
1571
1572@defmac SF_SIZE
1573@defmacx DF_SIZE
1574@defmacx XF_SIZE
1575@defmacx TF_SIZE
1576Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1577@code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1578if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1579@code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1580for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1581@code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
a18bdccd 1582@code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
38f8b050
JR
1583@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1584@end defmac
1585
1586@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1587A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1588assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1589default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1590@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1591@end defmac
1592
1593@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1594A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1595supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1596value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1597If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1598is the default.
1599@end defmac
1600
1601@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1602An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1603@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1604always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1605and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1606@end defmac
1607
1608@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1609This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1610@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1611of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1612@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1613
1614The default is to return false.
1615@end deftypefn
1616
1617@defmac SIZE_TYPE
1618A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1619for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1620contents of the string.
1621
1622The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1623spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1624appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1625of the data type names defined in the function
1626@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1627omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1628crash on startup.
1629
1630If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1631int"}.
1632@end defmac
1633
1634@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1635A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1636for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1637@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1638@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1639
1640If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1641@end defmac
1642
1643@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1644A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1645for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1646the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1647information.
1648
1649If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1650@end defmac
1651
1652@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1653A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1654characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1655@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1656@end defmac
1657
1658@defmac WINT_TYPE
1659A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1660use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1661@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1662contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1663information.
1664
1665If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1666@end defmac
1667
1668@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1669A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1670can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1671The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1672string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1673
1674If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1675@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1676much precision as @code{long long int}.
1677@end defmac
1678
1679@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1680A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1681can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1682type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1683of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1684
1685If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1686@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1687unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1688int}.
1689@end defmac
1690
1691@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1692@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1693@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1694@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1695@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1696@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1697@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1698@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1699@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1700@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1701@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1702@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1703@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1704@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1705@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1706@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1707@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1708@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1709@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1710@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1711@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1712@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1713@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1714@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1715@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1716@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1717@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1718C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1719@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1720@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1721@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1722@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1723@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1724@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1725@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1726@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1727@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1728
1729If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1730type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1731@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1732to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1733these macros are null pointers.
1734@end defmac
1735
1736@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1737The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1738that looks like:
1739
1740@smallexample
1741 struct @{
1742 union @{
1743 void (*fn)();
1744 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1745 @};
1746 ptrdiff_t delta;
1747 @};
1748@end smallexample
1749
1750@noindent
1751The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1752will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1753Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1754always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1755distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1756platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1757that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1758the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1759
1760GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1761this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1762However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1763set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1764bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1765address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1766architecture, you should define this macro to
1767@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1768
1769In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1770in which function addresses are always even, according to
1771@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1772@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1773@end defmac
1774
1775@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1776Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1777macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1778instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1779function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1780data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1781pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1782
1783If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1784of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1785@end defmac
1786
1787@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1788By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1789is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1790the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1791when special alignment is necessary. */
1792@end defmac
1793
1794@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1795There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1796zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1797specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1798of words in each data entry.
1799@end defmac
1800
1801@node Registers
1802@section Register Usage
1803@cindex register usage
1804
1805This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1806has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1807
1808The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1809done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1810on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1811For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1812For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1813
1814@menu
1815* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1816* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1817* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1818* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1819* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1820@end menu
1821
1822@node Register Basics
1823@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1824
1825@c prevent bad page break with this line
1826Registers have various characteristics.
1827
1828@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1829Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1830numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1831pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1832@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1833@end defmac
1834
1835@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1836@cindex fixed register
1837An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1838all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1839general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1840pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1841register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1842machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1843and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1844
1845This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1846commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1847register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1848
1849The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1850the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1851by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1852the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1853@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1854@end defmac
1855
1856@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1857@cindex call-used register
1858@cindex call-clobbered register
1859@cindex call-saved register
1860Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1861clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1862registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1863available for general allocation of values that must live across
1864function calls.
1865
1866If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1867automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1868exit, if the register is used within the function.
1869@end defmac
1870
1871@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1872@cindex call-used register
1873@cindex call-clobbered register
1874@cindex call-saved register
1875Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1876that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1877(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1878This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1879of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1880@end defmac
1881
1882@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1883@cindex call-used register
1884@cindex call-clobbered register
1885@cindex call-saved register
1886A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1887value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1888call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1889macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1890preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1891@end defmac
1892
1893@findex fixed_regs
1894@findex call_used_regs
1895@findex global_regs
1896@findex reg_names
1897@findex reg_class_contents
5efd84c5
NF
1898@hook TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1899This hook may conditionally modify five variables
38f8b050
JR
1900@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1901@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1902any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1903of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1904@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1905@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1906called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1907@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1908from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1909@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1910@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1911@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1912command options have been applied.
1913
38f8b050
JR
1914@cindex disabling certain registers
1915@cindex controlling register usage
1916If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1917flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1918@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1919registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1920the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1921to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1922is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1923
1924(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1925of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1926controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1927these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
5efd84c5 1928@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
1929
1930@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1931Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1932expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1933corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1934function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1935outbound register.
1936@end defmac
1937
1938@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1939Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1940expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1941corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1942function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1943register.
1944@end defmac
1945
1946@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1947Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1948expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1949register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1950need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1951gotos.
1952@end defmac
1953
1954@defmac PC_REGNUM
1955If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1956register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1957@end defmac
1958
1959@node Allocation Order
1960@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1961@cindex order of register allocation
1962@cindex register allocation order
1963
1964@c prevent bad page break with this line
1965Registers are allocated in order.
1966
1967@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1968If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1969numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1970to use them (from most preferred to least).
1971
1972If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1973(all else being equal).
1974
1975One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1976registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1977instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1978machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1979the highest numbered allocable register first.
1980@end defmac
1981
1982@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1983A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1984hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1985
1986Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1987Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1988register; and so on.
1989
1990The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1991@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1992
1993On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
1994@end defmac
1995
1996@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1997Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
1998prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
1999using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2000allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2001call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2002should be defined.
2003@end defmac
2004
2005@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2006In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2007Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2008If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2009based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2010be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2011value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2012to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2013
2014On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2015@end defmac
2016
2017@node Values in Registers
2018@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2019
2020This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2021(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2022consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2023
2024@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2025A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2026at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2027@var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2028cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2029and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2030
2031On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2032definition of this macro is
2033
2034@smallexample
2035#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2036 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2037 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2038@end smallexample
2039@end defmac
2040
2041@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2042A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2043in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2044in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2045multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2046this mode by the number of registers returned by
2047@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2048
2049For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2050registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2051nonzero.
2052
2053This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2054@code{subreg_get_info}
2055would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2056represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2057@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2058registers and so not be representable.
2059@end defmac
2060
2061@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2062For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2063@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2064returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2065including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2066@end defmac
2067
2068@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2069Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2070of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2071should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2072used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2073happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2074floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2075@end defmac
2076
2077@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2078A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2079of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2080registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2081are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2082
2083@smallexample
2084#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2085@end smallexample
2086
2087You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2088because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2089
2090@cindex register pairs
2091On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2092register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2093odd register numbers for such modes.
2094
2095The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2096@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2097register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2098value into the register and back out not alter it.
2099
2100Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2101all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2102@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2103you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2104is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2105and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2106to be tieable.
2107
2108Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2109Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2110in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2111can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2112mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2113registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2114
2115On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2116modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2117registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2118non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2119@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2120floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2121normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2122unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2123register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2124
2125The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2126they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2127instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2128@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2129constraints for those instructions.
2130
2131On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2132so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2133register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2134floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2135be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2136@end defmac
2137
2138@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2139A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2140@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2141
2142One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2143another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2144handler.
2145
2146The default is always nonzero.
2147@end defmac
2148
2149@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2150A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2151@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2152
2153If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2154@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2155any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2156should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2157this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2158accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2159
2160You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2161possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2162allocation.
2163@end defmac
2164
2165@hook TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK
2166This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2167@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2168
2169One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2170is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2171
2172The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2173@end deftypefn
2174
2175@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2176Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2177registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2178@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2179@end defmac
2180
2181@node Leaf Functions
2182@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2183
2184@cindex leaf functions
2185@cindex functions, leaf
2186On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2187more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2188means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2189are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2190normally arrive.
2191
2192The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2193other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2194registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2195function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2196handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2197functions''.
2198
2199GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2200suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2201registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2202accomplish this.
2203
2204@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2205Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2206contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2207function treatment.
2208
2209If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2210registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2211GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2212used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2213in this vector.
2214
2215Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2216the treatment of leaf functions.
2217@end defmac
2218
2219@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2220A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2221should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2222
2223If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2224function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2225will cause the compiler to abort.
2226
2227Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2228treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2229this.
2230@end defmac
2231
2232@findex current_function_is_leaf
2233@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2234@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2235@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2236specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2237which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2238set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2239compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2240@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2241functions which only use leaf registers.
2242@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2243that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2244@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2245@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2246@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2247
2248@node Stack Registers
2249@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2250
2251There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2252``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2253pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2254stack.
2255
2256Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2257they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2258support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2259point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2260stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2261@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2262with it, as well as defining these macros.
2263
2264@defmac STACK_REGS
2265Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2266@end defmac
2267
2268@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2269This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2270the machine has any stack-like registers.
2271@end defmac
2272
2273@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2274The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2275of the stack.
2276@end defmac
2277
2278@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2279The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2280the stack.
2281@end defmac
2282
2283@node Register Classes
2284@section Register Classes
2285@cindex register class definitions
2286@cindex class definitions, register
2287
2288On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2289For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2290certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2291restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2292
2293You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2294which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2295that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2296
2297@findex ALL_REGS
2298@findex NO_REGS
2299In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2300class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2301class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2302union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2303
2304@findex GENERAL_REGS
2305One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2306terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2307@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2308the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2309to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2310
2311Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2312then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2313
2314The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2315constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2316You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2317them in operand constraints.
2318
2319You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2320instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2321either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2322certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
b899fd78
JR
2323which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2324or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2325the class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
38f8b050
JR
2326
2327You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2328classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2329contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2330in their union.
2331
2332When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2333certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2334Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2335a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2336specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2337
2338Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2339instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2340each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2341mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2342single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2343this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2344instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2345single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2346@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2347
2348@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2349An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2350as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2351must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2352@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2353tells how many classes there are.
2354
2355Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2356the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2357in many of the tables described below.
2358@end deftp
2359
2360@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2361The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2362
2363@smallexample
2364#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2365@end smallexample
2366@end defmac
2367
2368@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2369An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2370constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2371@end defmac
2372
2373@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2374An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2375which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2376@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2377register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2378
2379When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2380Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2381several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2382for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2383In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2384registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2385so on.
2386@end defmac
2387
2388@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2389A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2390@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2391which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2392register.
2393@end defmac
2394
2395@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2396A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2397base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2398which is the register value plus a displacement.
2399@end defmac
2400
2401@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2402This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2403the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2404@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2405@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2406@end defmac
2407
2408@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2409A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2410base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2411register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2412addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2413@end defmac
2414
2415@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2416A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2417base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2418context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
2419the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2420address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2421@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2422index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2423@end defmac
2424
2425@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2426A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2427index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2428address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2429added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2430@end defmac
2431
2432@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2433A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2434suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
38f8b050
JR
2435@end defmac
2436
2437@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2438A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2439that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2440@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2441reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2442you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2443@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2444addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2445@code{address_operand}.
38f8b050
JR
2446@end defmac
2447
2448@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2449A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2450use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2451memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2452pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2453define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2454than other base register uses.
2455
2456Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2457@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
38f8b050
JR
2458@end defmac
2459
2460@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2461A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2462that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2463appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2464immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2465address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2466@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2467corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2468@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2469that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
38f8b050
JR
2470@end defmac
2471
2472@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2473A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2474suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2475either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2476allocated such a hard register.
2477
2478The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2479the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2480two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2481labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2482labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2483may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2484looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2485only if neither labeling works.
38f8b050
JR
2486@end defmac
2487
5f286f4a
YQ
2488@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS
2489
fba42e24
AS
2490@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2491A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2492to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2493@var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2494another, smaller class.
2495
2496The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2497
2498Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2499example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2500for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2501@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2502Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2503
2504One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2505@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2506loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2507force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2508immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2509instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2510register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2511@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2512into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2513@code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2514of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2515
2516If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2517through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2518to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2519reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2520this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2521the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2522@end deftypefn
2523
38f8b050
JR
2524@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2525A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2526to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2527@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2528another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2529safe:
2530
2531@smallexample
2532#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2533@end smallexample
2534
2535Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2536example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2537for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2538@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2539Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2540
2541One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2542@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2543loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2544force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2545immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2546instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2547register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2548@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2549into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2550@code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2551of using @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2552
2553If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2554through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2555to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2556reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2557this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2558the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2559@end defmac
2560
2561@defmac PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2562Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2563input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2564@var{class}, unchanged.
2565
2566You can also use @code{PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2567reload from using some alternatives, like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2568@end defmac
2569
abd26bfb
AS
2570@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2571Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2572input reloads.
2573
2574The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2575argument.
2576
2577You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2578reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2579@end deftypefn
2580
38f8b050
JR
2581@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2582A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2583to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2584@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2585ordinarily be used.
2586
2587Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2588there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2589
2590The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2591smaller class.
2592
2593Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2594require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2595@end defmac
2596
2597@hook TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
2598Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2599from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2600@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2601from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2602term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2603directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2604register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2605destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2606source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2607reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2608and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2609intermediate register still holds the required value.
2610
2611Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2612allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2613register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2614address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2615when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2616as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2617that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2618describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2619these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2620of the scratch register(s).
2621
2622In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2623
2624For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2625and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2626@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2627hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2628needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2629
2630If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2631an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2632return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2633If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2634If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2635that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2636
2637If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2638perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2639closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2640required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2641copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2642
2643You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2644in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2645and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2646for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2647single-register-class
2648@c [later: or memory]
2649output constraint.
2650
2651When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2652hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2653register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2654have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2655
2656@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2657@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2658@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2659@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2660@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2661@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2662@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2663@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2664
2665
2666@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2667pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2668Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2669in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2670
2671Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2672currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2673to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2674
2675@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2676copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2677(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2678Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2679of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2680forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2681@end deftypefn
2682
2683@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2684@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2685@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2686These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2687@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2688
2689These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2690target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2691reload phase that it may
2692need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2693register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2694register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2695you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2696largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2697intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2698
2699If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2700intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2701was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2702class required. If the
2703requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2704@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2705macros identically.
2706
2707The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2708Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2709can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2710@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2711macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2712
2713If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2714intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2715@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2716(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2717implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2718@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2719register.
2720
2721These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2722register that
2723contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2724class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2725value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2726register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2727Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2728
2729@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2730pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2731Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2732in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2733
2734These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2735registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2736registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2737would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2738the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2739intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2740general registers.
2741@end defmac
2742
2743@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2744Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2745to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2746those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2747@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2748class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2749and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2750
2751Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2752@end defmac
2753
2754@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2755Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2756allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2757If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2758defined by this macro.
2759
2760Do not define this macro if you do not define
2761@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2762@end defmac
2763
2764@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2765When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2766registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2767hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2768load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2769same as that of @var{mode}.
2770
2771This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2772bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2773in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2774registers.
2775
2776However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2777the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2778differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2779widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2780suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2781details.
2782
2783Do not define this macro if you do not define
2784@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2785is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2786@end defmac
2787
07b8f0a8
AS
2788@hook TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2789A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2790to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2791registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2792
2793The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2794has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2795default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2796if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2797hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2798@code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2799@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2800register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2801you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2802the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2803allocation.
2804@end deftypefn
2805
38f8b050
JR
2806@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2807A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2808of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2809
2810This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2811the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2812should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2813@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2814
2815This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2816in the reload pass.
2817@end defmac
2818
2819@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2820If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2821a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2822
2823For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2824floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2825Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2826does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2827register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2828as below:
2829
2830@smallexample
2831#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2832 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2833 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2834@end smallexample
2835@end defmac
2836
38f8b050
JR
2837@node Old Constraints
2838@section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2839@cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2840@cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2841
2842Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2843of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2844Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2845it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2846
2847@defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2848For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2849@var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2850constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2851you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2852constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2853DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2854to handle specially.
2855There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2856for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2857transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2858return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2859will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2860@end defmac
2861
2862@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2863A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2864letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2865value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2866the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2867corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2868to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2869@end defmac
2870
2871@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2872Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2873passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2874different variants.
2875@end defmac
2876
2877@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2878A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2879letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2880particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2881letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2882the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2883not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2884@var{value}.
2885@end defmac
2886
2887@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2888Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2889string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2890between different variants.
2891@end defmac
2892
2893@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2894A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2895letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2896(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2897
2898If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2899@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2900range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2901letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2902
2903@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2904@code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2905or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2906between these kinds.
2907@end defmac
2908
2909@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2910Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2911string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2912between different variants.
2913@end defmac
2914
2915@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2916A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2917letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2918memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2919elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2920@code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2921may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2922
2923If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2924if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2925constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2926constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2927
2928For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2929in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2930letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2931@emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2932a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2933alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2934does not include r0 on the output.
2935@end defmac
2936
2937@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2938Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2939in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2940variants.
2941@end defmac
2942
2943@defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2944A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2945letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2946be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2947
2948It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2949at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2950comprises a subset of all memory references including
2951all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
2952pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2953type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2954
2955For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2956memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2957register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2958@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2959If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2960a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2961reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2962into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
2963an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
2964@end defmac
2965
2966@defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2967A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2968letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
2969@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
2970be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
2971
2972It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2973at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
2974a subset of all memory addresses including
2975all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
2976pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2977type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
2978
2979Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
2980be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
2981analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
2982@end defmac
2983
2984@node Stack and Calling
2985@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2986@cindex calling conventions
2987
2988@c prevent bad page break with this line
2989This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2990
2991@menu
2992* Frame Layout::
2993* Exception Handling::
2994* Stack Checking::
2995* Frame Registers::
2996* Elimination::
2997* Stack Arguments::
2998* Register Arguments::
2999* Scalar Return::
3000* Aggregate Return::
3001* Caller Saves::
3002* Function Entry::
3003* Profiling::
3004* Tail Calls::
3005* Stack Smashing Protection::
3006@end menu
3007
3008@node Frame Layout
3009@subsection Basic Stack Layout
3010@cindex stack frame layout
3011@cindex frame layout
3012
3013@c prevent bad page break with this line
3014Here is the basic stack layout.
3015
3016@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3017Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3018pointer to a smaller address.
3019
3020When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3021compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3022definition used does not matter.
3023@end defmac
3024
3025@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3026This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3027on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3028@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3029
3030The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3031and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3032the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3033to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3034space for the next item on the stack.
3035
3036The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3037defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3038which is often wrong.
3039@end defmac
3040
3041@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3042Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3043are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3044@end defmac
3045
3046@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3047Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3048addresses on the stack.
3049@end defmac
3050
3051@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3052Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3053
3054If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3055subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3056Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3057value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3058@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3059@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3060@end defmac
3061
3062@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3063Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3064The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3065
3066On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3067is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3068alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3069stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3070@end defmac
3071
3072@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3073Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3074outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3075zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3076
3077If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3078the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3079@end defmac
3080
3081@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3082Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3083address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3084function.
3085
3086If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3087the first argument's address.
3088@end defmac
3089
3090@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3091Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3092on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3093
3094The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3095length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3096machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3097@end defmac
3098
3099@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3100A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3101stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3102@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3103default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3104elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3105@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3106@end defmac
3107
3108@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3109A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3110frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3111@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3112itself.
3113
3114If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3115of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3116address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3117@end defmac
3118
3119@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3120If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3121setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3122on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3123before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3124define this macro.
3125@end defmac
3126
3127@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
3128This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3129the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3130The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3131machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3132@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3133@end deftypefn
3134
3135@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3136A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3137address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3138of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3139You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3140as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3141@end defmac
3142
3143@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3144A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3145address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3146the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3147frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3148@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3149
3150The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3151@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3152determine the return address of other frames.
3153@end defmac
3154
3155@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3156Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3157from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3158@end defmac
3159
3160@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3161A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3162incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3163prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3164value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3165the stack.
3166
3167You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3168debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3169
3170If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3171@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3172@end defmac
3173
3174@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3175A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3176number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3177must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3178be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3179
3180This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3181general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3182frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3183over time.
3184@end defmac
3185
3186@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3187A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3188number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3189only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3190someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3191terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3192@end defmac
3193
3194@hook TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC
3195This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3196contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3197info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3198@smallexample
3199(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3200@end smallexample
3201and
3202@smallexample
3203(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3204@end smallexample
3205to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3206the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3207the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3208@end deftypefn
3209
3210@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3211A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3212from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3213frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3214the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3215previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3216
3217You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3218debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3219@end defmac
3220
3221@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3222A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3223from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3224final value should coincide with that calculated by
3225@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3226during virtual register instantiation.
3227
3228The default value for this macro is
3229@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3230which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3231immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3232some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3233and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3234
3235You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3236want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3237DWARF 2.
3238@end defmac
3239
3240@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3241If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3242in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3243The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3244@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3245
3246Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3247via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3248variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3249defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3250based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3251of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3252should be defined.
3253@end defmac
3254
3255@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3256If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3257in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3258in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3259may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3260@end defmac
3261
3262@node Exception Handling
3263@subsection Exception Handling Support
3264@cindex exception handling
3265
3266@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3267A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3268data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3269@var{N} registers are usable.
3270
3271The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3272handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3273should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3274but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
32752 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3276
3277You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3278handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3279@end defmac
3280
3281@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3282A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3283to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3284This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3285It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3286
3287Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3288untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3289
3290Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3291by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3292this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3293stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3294this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3295that provided by DWARF 2.
3296@end defmac
3297
3298@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3299A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3300to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3301return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3302
3303Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3304return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3305address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3306the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3307frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3308been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3309target call frame.
3310
3311Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3312address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3313the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3314
3315If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3316define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3317@end defmac
3318
3319@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3320If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3321to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3322exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3323using it to return to the exception handler.
3324@end defmac
3325
3326@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3327This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3328handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3329that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3330and so may be read-only.
3331
3332@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3333@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3334The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3335as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3336
3337If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3338represented directly.
3339@end defmac
3340
3341@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3342This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3343to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3344Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3345be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3346
3347This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3348handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3349of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3350to be emitted.
3351@end defmac
3352
3353@defmac MD_UNWIND_SUPPORT
3354A string specifying a file to be #include'd in unwind-dw2.c. The file
3355so included typically defines @code{MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR}.
3356@end defmac
3357
3358@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3359This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3360code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3361available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3362through signal frames.
3363
3364This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3365@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3366@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3367@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3368for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3369the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3370save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3371evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3372the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3373
3374For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3375@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3376@end defmac
3377
3378@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3379This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3380call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3381usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3382
3383This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3384@var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3385@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3386for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3387@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3388be updated in @var{fs}.
3389@end defmac
3390
3391@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3392A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3393info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3394linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3395@end defmac
3396
3397@node Stack Checking
3398@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3399
3400GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3401stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3402three ways:
3403
3404@enumerate
3405@item
3406If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3407will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3408at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3409other special processing.
3410
3411@item
3412If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3413@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3414that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3415static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3416in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3417stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3418approach below.
3419
3420@item
3421If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3422``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3423@end enumerate
3424
3425If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3426GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3427@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3428dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3429
3430@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3431A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3432machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3433is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3434checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3435value of this macro is zero.
3436@end defmac
3437
3438@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3439A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3440in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3441like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3442approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3443@end defmac
3444
3445@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3446An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3447instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3448define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3449the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3450of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3451@end defmac
3452
3453@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3454An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3455when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3456contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3457thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3458is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3459default value of this macro is zero.
3460@end defmac
3461
3462@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3463The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3464languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3465with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
34668192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3467most machines.
3468@end defmac
3469
3470The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3471nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3472in the opposite case.
3473
3474@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3475The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3476instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3477stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3478checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3479default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3480systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3481@end defmac
3482
3483@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3484GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3485represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3486space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3487You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3488use the default of four words.
3489@end defmac
3490
3491@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3492The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3493fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3494@option{-fstack-check}.
3495GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3496normally not need to override that default.
3497@end defmac
3498
3499@need 2000
3500@node Frame Registers
3501@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3502
3503@c prevent bad page break with this line
3504This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3505
3506@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3507The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3508fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3509the hardware determines which register this is.
3510@end defmac
3511
3512@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3513The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3514access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3515hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3516choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3517@end defmac
3518
3519@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3520On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3521offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3522allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3523between these two locations). On those machines, define
3524@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3525be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3526@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3527used for the frame pointer.
3528
3529You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3530is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3531the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3532completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3533definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3534@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3535or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3536
3537Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3538@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3539@end defmac
3540
3541@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3542The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3543the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3544frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3545register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3546wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3547pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3548@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3549(@pxref{Elimination}).
3550@end defmac
3551
e3339d0f
JM
3552@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3553Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3554@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3555the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3556== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3557definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3558@end defmac
3559
3560@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3561Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3562@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3563same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3564ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3565definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3566@end defmac
3567
38f8b050
JR
3568@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3569The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3570access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3571machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3572pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3573to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3574@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3575
3576Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3577address from the stack.
3578@end defmac
3579
3580@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3581@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3582Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3583register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3584function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3585number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3586these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3587not be defined.
3588
3589The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3590
3591If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3592defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3593@end defmac
3594
3595@hook TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN
3596This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3597targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3598nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3599attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3600those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3601
3602The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3603
3604If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3605provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3606Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3607from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3608will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3609@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3610@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3611@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3612The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3613@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3614to refer to those items.
3615@end deftypefn
3616
3617@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3618This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3619saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3620DWARF2 exception handling.
3621
3622Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3623exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3624extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3625in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3626used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3627routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3628registers that are not call-saved.
3629
3630If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3631@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3632@end defmac
3633
3634@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3635
3636This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3637for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3638
3639If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3640@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3641@end defmac
3642
3643@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3644
3645Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3646is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3647Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3648column number to use instead.
3649
3650See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3651@end defmac
3652
3653@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3654
3655Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3656used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3657debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3658should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3659@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3660
3661@end defmac
3662
3663@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3664
3665Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3666that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3667should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3668.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3669return @code{@var{regno}}.
3670
3671@end defmac
3672
3673@node Elimination
3674@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3675
3676@c prevent bad page break with this line
3677This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3678
3679@hook TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3680This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3681a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3682value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3683
3684This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3685according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3686constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3687to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3688Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3689pointer.
3690
3691In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3692without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3693automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3694@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3695them.
3696
3697In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3698register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3699fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3700
3701Default return value is @code{false}.
3702@end deftypefn
3703
3704@findex get_frame_size
3705@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3706A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3707between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3708the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3709such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3710registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3711
3712If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3713need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3714@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3715case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3716@end defmac
3717
3718@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3719If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3720eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3721defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3722references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3723
3724The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3725of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3726
3727On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3728the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3729must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3730replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3731depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3732
3733In this case, you might specify:
3734@smallexample
3735#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3736@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3737 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3738 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3739@end smallexample
3740
3741Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3742specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3743@end defmac
3744
3745@hook TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
3746This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3747try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3748@var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3749is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3750preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3751knows about.
3752
3753Default return value is @code{true}.
3754@end deftypefn
3755
3756@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3757This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3758specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3759registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3760defined.
3761@end defmac
3762
3763@node Stack Arguments
3764@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3765@cindex arguments on stack
3766@cindex stack arguments
3767
3768The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3769on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3770control passing certain arguments in registers.
3771
3772@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3773This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3774prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3775passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3776cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3777The default is to not promote prototypes.
3778@end deftypefn
3779
3780@defmac PUSH_ARGS
3781A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3782outgoing arguments.
3783If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3784That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3785allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3786it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3787@end defmac
3788
3789@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3790A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3791last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3792defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3793and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3794@end defmac
3795
3796@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3797A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3798stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3799
3800On some machines, the definition
3801
3802@smallexample
3803#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3804@end smallexample
3805
3806@noindent
3807will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3808to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3809alignment. Then the definition should be
3810
3811@smallexample
3812#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3813@end smallexample
4a6336ad 3814
64ad7c99 3815If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
3816@end defmac
3817
3818@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3819@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3820A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3821will be computed and placed into the variable
3822@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3823onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3824increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3825
3826Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3827is not proper.
3828@end defmac
3829
3830@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3831Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3832allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3833registers.
3834
3835The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3836arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3837which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3838The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3839of the function.
3840
3841This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3842machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3843which.
3844@end defmac
3845@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3846@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3847
3848@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3849Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3850caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3851when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3852if the function called is a library function.
3853
3854If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3855whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3856@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3857@end defmac
3858
3859@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3860Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3861stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3862@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3863@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3864
3865Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3866stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3867suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3868stack in its natural location.
3869@end defmac
3870
893d13d5 3871@hook TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS
38f8b050
JR
3872This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3873a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3874and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3875
3876@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3877the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3878@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3879From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3880
3881@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3882describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3883@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3884From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3885arguments (if known).
3886
3887When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3888will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3889you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3890by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3891a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3892in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3893
893d13d5 3894@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
38f8b050
JR
3895stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3896argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3897
3898On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
893d13d5 3899of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
38f8b050
JR
3900calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3901the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3902convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3903arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3904nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3905@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3906number of arguments.
3907@end deftypefn
3908
3909@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3910A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3911pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3912when compiling a function call.
3913
3914@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3915have been accumulated.
3916
3917On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3918that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3919that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3920call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3921appropriate.
3922@end defmac
3923
3924@node Register Arguments
3925@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3926@cindex arguments in registers
3927@cindex registers arguments
3928
3929This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3930types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3931the stack.
3932
b25b9e8f
NF
3933@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG
3934Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3935register and if so, which register.
38f8b050 3936
b25b9e8f 3937The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
38f8b050
JR
3938arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3939the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3940(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
b25b9e8f
NF
3941which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3942nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3943function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3944syntax error has previously occurred.
38f8b050 3945
b25b9e8f
NF
3946The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3947register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3948on the stack.
38f8b050
JR
3949
3950The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3951used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3952@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3953@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3954describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3955@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3956register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3957register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3958second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3959the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3960As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3961RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3962argument is also stored on the stack.
3963
b25b9e8f 3964The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
38f8b050
JR
3965VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3966pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3967
3968@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
b25b9e8f
NF
3969The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
3970machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
3971cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
3972done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
3973@var{named} is @code{false}.
3974
3975@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3976@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
38f8b050
JR
3977You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
3978in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3979type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
b25b9e8f 3980is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
38f8b050
JR
3981argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3982defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3983a register.
b25b9e8f 3984@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
3985
3986@hook TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
3987This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
3988solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
3989definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3990documentation.
3991@end deftypefn
3992
b25b9e8f
NF
3993@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
3994Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
38f8b050
JR
3995that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
3996necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
3997argument.
3998
b25b9e8f
NF
3999For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4000which the caller passes the value, and
4001@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4002fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4003arrive.
38f8b050 4004
b25b9e8f
NF
4005If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4006@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4007@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4008
4009@hook TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
4010This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4011argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4012arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4013pushed on the stack.
4014
4015On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4016registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4017first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4018on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4019structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4020in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4021compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4022
b25b9e8f 4023@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
38f8b050 4024register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
b25b9e8f 4025@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
38f8b050
JR
4026@end deftypefn
4027
ec9f85e5 4028@hook TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
38f8b050
JR
4029This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4030position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4031predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4032passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4033
4034If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4035pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4036The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4037to that type.
4038@end deftypefn
4039
4040@hook TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
4041The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4042known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4043function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4044by the caller.
4045
4046For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4047determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4048not be generated.
4049
4050The default version of this hook always returns false.
4051@end deftypefn
4052
4053@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
b25b9e8f
NF
4054A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4055of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4056target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4057of bytes of argument so far.
38f8b050
JR
4058
4059There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4060arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4061variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4062arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4063@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4064should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4065@end defmac
4066
4067@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4068If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4069function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4070created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4071reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4072If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4073@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4074@end defmac
4075
4076@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4077A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4078@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4079variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4080is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4081the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4082For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4083declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4084@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4085being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4086arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4087parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4088@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4089
4090When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4091@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4092contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4093an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4094macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4095never both of them at once.
4096@end defmac
4097
4098@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4099Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4100it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4101@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4102is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
41030)} is used instead.
4104@end defmac
4105
4106@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4107Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4108finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4109undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4110
4111The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4112with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4113argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4114@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4115@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4116@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4117@end defmac
4118
b25b9e8f
NF
4119@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
4120This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4121advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4122@var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4123the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4124argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
38f8b050 4125
b25b9e8f 4126This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
38f8b050
JR
4127on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4128used for arguments without any special help.
b25b9e8f 4129@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4130
4131@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4132If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4133offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4134which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4135slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4136top.
4137@end defmac
4138
4139@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4140If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4141to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4142@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4143@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4144
4145The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
c2ed6cf8
NF
4146multiple of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not
4147control it.
38f8b050
JR
4148
4149This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4150For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4151big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4152constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4153@end defmac
4154
4155@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4156If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4157implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4158next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4159controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4160arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4161@end defmac
4162
4163@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4164Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4165memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4166macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4167machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4168@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4169registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4170a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4171required.
4172@end defmac
4173
c2ed6cf8 4174@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
2b0d3573 4175This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
c2ed6cf8
NF
4176with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4177@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4178@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4179
4180@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4181A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4182register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4183@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4184the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4185used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4186stack.
4187@end defmac
4188
4189@hook TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
4190This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4191as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4192arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4193to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4194AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4195registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4196point register.
4197
4198The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4199false.
4200@end deftypefn
4201
4202@hook TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
4203This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4204The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4205@end deftypefn
4206
07a5b2bc 4207@hook TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P
38f8b050
JR
4208This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4209to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4210variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
07a5b2bc 4211to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
38f8b050 4212variable.
07a5b2bc 4213The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
38f8b050
JR
4214this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4215internal type.
4216If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4217Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4218macro to iterate through all types.
4219@end deftypefn
4220
4221@hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST
4222This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4223@var{fndecl}.
4224The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4225@end deftypefn
4226
4227@hook TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE
4228This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4229type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4230@code{NULL_TREE}.
4231@end deftypefn
4232
4233@hook TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
4234This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4235@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4236arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4237@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4238@end deftypefn
4239
4240@hook TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
4241Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4242with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4243hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4244@end deftypefn
4245
7352c013
RG
4246@hook TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO
4247
38f8b050
JR
4248@hook TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4249Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4250insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4251considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4252must work.
4253
4254The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4255required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4256Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4257code in @file{optabs.c}.
4258@end deftypefn
4259
4260@hook TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4261Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4262insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4263must have move patterns for this mode.
4264@end deftypefn
4265
4266@hook TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P
4267Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4268small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4269@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4270in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4271In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4272for any mode.
4273
4274On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4275insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4276to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4277if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4278insn.
4279
4280Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4281in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4282the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4283classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4284registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4285registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4286SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4287strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4288machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4289
2b0d3573 4290The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
38f8b050
JR
4291safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4292unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4293that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4294to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4295of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4296@end deftypefn
4297
e692f276
RH
4298@hook TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4299
38f8b050
JR
4300@node Scalar Return
4301@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4302@cindex return values in registers
4303@cindex values, returned by functions
4304@cindex scalars, returned as values
4305
4306This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4307values---values that can fit in registers.
4308
4309@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
4310
4311Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4312returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4313representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4314representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4315function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4316compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4317Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4318a function returns a value.
4319
4320On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4321(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4322place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4323@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4324The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
b25b9e8f 4325multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
38f8b050
JR
4326@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4327location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4328the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4329that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4330port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4331@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4332
4333If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4334the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4335@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4336
4337If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4338node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4339pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4340convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4341known.
4342
4343Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4344which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4345the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4346different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4347
4348@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4349aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4350@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4351@end deftypefn
4352
4353@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4354This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4355a new target instead.
4356@end defmac
4357
4358@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4359A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4360function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4361
4362Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4363support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4364specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4365compiled.
4366@end defmac
4367
4368@hook TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
4369Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4370function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4371
4372The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4373library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4374representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4375
4376If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4377@end deftypefn
4378
4379@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4380A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4381register in which the values of called function may come back.
4382
4383A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4384second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4385recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4386suffices:
4387
4388@smallexample
4389#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4390@end smallexample
4391
4392If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4393function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4394should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4395
4396This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4397for a new target instead.
4398@end defmac
4399
4400@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
4401A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4402register in which the values of called function may come back.
4403
4404A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4405second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4406recognized by this target hook.
4407
4408If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4409function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4410should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4411
4412If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4413@end deftypefn
4414
4415@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4416Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4417need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4418saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4419@end defmac
4420
4421@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
4422This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4423at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4424padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4425is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4426
4427Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4428be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4429or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
44304-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4431@code{SImode} rtx.
4432@end deftypefn
4433
4434@node Aggregate Return
4435@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4436@cindex aggregates as return values
4437@cindex large return values
4438@cindex returning aggregate values
4439@cindex structure value address
4440
4441When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4442cases), the value is not returned according to
4443@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4444caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4445should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4446address}.
4447
4448This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4449memory.
4450
4451@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
4452This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4453function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4454Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4455will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4456libcalls.
4457
4458Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4459by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4460takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4461possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4462definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4463values, and 0 otherwise.
4464
4465Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4466be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4467to indicate this.
4468@end deftypefn
4469
4470@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4471Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4472in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4473only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4474If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4475and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4476target hook.
4477
4478If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4479@end defmac
4480
4481@hook TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
4482This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4483address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4484passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4485be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4486hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4487argument.
4488
4489On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4490is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4491caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4492be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4493@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4494the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4495the caller.
4496
4497If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4498stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4499@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4500structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4501to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4502@end deftypefn
4503
4504@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4505Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4506for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4507the address of a static variable containing the value.
4508
4509Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4510pass an address to the subroutine.
4511
4512This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4513nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4514@end defmac
4515
ffa88471
SE
4516@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE
4517
4518@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE
4519
38f8b050
JR
4520@node Caller Saves
4521@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4522
4523If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4524makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4525must live across calls.
4526
4527@defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4528A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4529a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4530restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4531this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4532
4533If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4534machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4535@end defmac
4536
4537@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4538A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4539of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4540@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4541returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4542will select the smallest suitable mode.
4543@end defmac
4544
4545@node Function Entry
4546@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4547@cindex function entry and exit
4548@cindex prologue
4549@cindex epilogue
4550
4551This section describes the macros that output function entry
4552(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4553
4554@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
4555If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4556function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4557initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4558saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4559local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4560stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4561
4562The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4563macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4564
4565@findex regs_ever_live
4566To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4567@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4568@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4569prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4570call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4571@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4572
4573On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4574not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4575they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4576appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4577registers are used in the function.
4578
4579@findex frame_pointer_needed
4580On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4581function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4582pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4583frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4584@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4585time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4586
4587The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4588required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4589listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4590order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4591stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4592the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4593for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4594compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4595or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4596need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4597@end deftypefn
4598
4599@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
4600If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4601prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4602emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4603emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4604@end deftypefn
4605
4606@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE
4607If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4608epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4609emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4610emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4611@end deftypefn
4612
4613@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
4614If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4615function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4616registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4617called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4618same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4619registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4620@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4621
4622On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4623of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4624instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4625@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4626
4627Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4628@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4629switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4630define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4631target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4632condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4633
4634On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4635function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4636two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4637is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4638@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4639a function that needs a frame pointer.
4640
4641Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4642@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4643The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4644function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4645
4646On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4647others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4648given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4649number of arguments.
4650
4651@findex current_function_pops_args
4652Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4653functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4654needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4655function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4656@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4657@end deftypefn
4658
4659@itemize @bullet
4660@item
4661@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4662A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4663uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4664stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4665if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4666arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4667yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4668region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4669registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4670features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4671
4672@item
4673An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4674The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4675the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4676machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4677in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4678a save area.
4679
4680@item
4681A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4682boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4683this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4684save area closer to the top of the stack.
4685
4686@item
4687@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4688Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4689@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4690argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4691@end itemize
4692
4693@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4694Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4695instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4696pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4697adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4698default is 0.
4699
4700Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4701frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4702stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4703compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4704@end defmac
4705
4706@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4707Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4708used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4709pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4710@end defmac
4711
4712@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4713Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4714used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4715on entry to an exception edge.
4716@end defmac
4717
4718@defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4719Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4720instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4721definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4722representing the number of delay slots there.
4723@end defmac
4724
4725@defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4726A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4727slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4728
4729The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4730being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4731eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4732of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4733If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4734may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4735(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4736slot.
4737
4738@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4739@findex final_scan_insn
4740The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4741list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4742@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4743delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4744@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4745outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4746@code{final_scan_insn}.
4747
4748You need not define this macro if you did not define
4749@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4750@end defmac
4751
4752@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4753A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4754function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4755inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4756adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4757the real function.
4758
4759First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4760contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4761contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4762in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4763e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4764all other incoming arguments.
4765
4766Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4767made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4768adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4769
4770@smallexample
4771p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4772@end smallexample
4773
4774After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4775@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4776not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4777return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4778
4779The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4780the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4781of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4782and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4783
4784The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4785have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4786some targets, but probably not.
4787
4788If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4789front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4790@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4791not support varargs.
4792@end deftypefn
4793
4794@hook TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4795A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4796to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4797arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4798generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4799previously exposed.
4800@end deftypefn
4801
4802@node Profiling
4803@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4804@cindex profiling, code generation
4805
4806These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4807
4808@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4809A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4810assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4811
4812@findex mcount
4813The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4814your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4815compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4816compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4817
4818Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4819variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4820@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4821the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4822@end defmac
4823
4824@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4825A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4826code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4827not support profiling.
4828@end defmac
4829
4830@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4831Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4832@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4833allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4834implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4835@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4836@end defmac
4837
4838@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4839Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4840the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4841@end defmac
4842
4843@node Tail Calls
4844@subsection Permitting tail calls
4845@cindex tail calls
4846
4847@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4848True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4849call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4850or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4851
4852It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4853tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4854during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4855as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4856``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4857may vary greatly between different architectures.
4858@end deftypefn
4859
4860@hook TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
4861Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4862function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4863cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4864registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4865TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4866FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4867@end deftypefn
4868
4869@node Stack Smashing Protection
4870@subsection Stack smashing protection
4871@cindex stack smashing protection
4872
4873@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD
4874This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4875for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4876runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4877that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4878variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4879
4880The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4881@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4882@end deftypefn
4883
4884@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL
4885This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4886stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4887involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4888
4889The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4890@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4891normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4892@end deftypefn
4893
7458026b
ILT
4894@hook TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK
4895
38f8b050
JR
4896@node Varargs
4897@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4898@cindex varargs implementation
4899
4900GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4901@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4902on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4903varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4904conditionals to include it.
4905
4906ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4907the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4908implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4909to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4910@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4911supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4912
4913However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4914the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4915below.
4916
4917@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4918Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4919that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4920versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4921you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4922
4923On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4924control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4925other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4926found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4927
4928Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4929beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4930@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4931This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4932to use them for its own purposes.
4933@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4934@c 10feb93
4935@end defmac
4936
38f8b050 4937@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
c59a0a1d 4938This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
38f8b050
JR
4939argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4940returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4941argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4942fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4943verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4944of the current function.
4945@end defmac
4946
4947@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4948Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4949passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4950has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4951specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4952with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4953
4954@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4955considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4956kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4957
4958The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4959interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4960@end defmac
4961
4962These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4963
4964@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
4965If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
4966@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
4967beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
4968return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
4969to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4970@end deftypefn
4971
4972@hook TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
4973This target hook offers an alternative to using
4974@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
4975@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
4976register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
4977have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
4978use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
4979pass all their arguments on the stack.
4980
4981The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
4982structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
4983named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
4984last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
4985
4986The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
4987argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
4988store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
4989variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
4990store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
4991frame.
4992
4993Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
4994compile time without knowing their data types,
4995@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
4996have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
4997for all data types.
4998
4999If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5000arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5001happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5002end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5003not generate any instructions in this case.
5004@end deftypefn
5005
5006@hook TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
5007Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5008argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5009
b25b9e8f 5010This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
38f8b050
JR
5011is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5012@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5013arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5014but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5015then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5016except the last are treated as named.
5017
5018You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5019@end deftypefn
5020
5021@hook TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
5022If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5023@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5024@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5025defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5026@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5027Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5028@end deftypefn
5029
5030@node Trampolines
5031@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5032@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5033@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5034
5035A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5036when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5037the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5038tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5039trampoline.
5040
5041The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5042address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5043the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5044two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5045exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5046machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5047two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5048operands.
5049
5050The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5051parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5052immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5053simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5054proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5055may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5056separately.
5057
5058@hook TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
5059This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5060on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5061the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5062label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5063
5064If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5065for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5066code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5067to generate it on the spot.
5068@end deftypefn
5069
5070@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5071Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5072(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5073@end defmac
5074
5075@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5076A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5077@end defmac
5078
5079@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5080Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5081
5082If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5083is used for aligning trampolines.
5084@end defmac
5085
5086@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
5087This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5088@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5089is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5090RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5091when it is called.
5092
5093If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5094first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5095from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5096Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5097trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5098to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5099
5100If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5101enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5102initializing the trampoline proper.
5103@end deftypefn
5104
5105@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
5106This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5107the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5108memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5109the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5110address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5111be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5112If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5113@end deftypefn
5114
5115Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5116separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5117fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5118jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5119
5120Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5121the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5122make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5123subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5124latter makes initialization faster.
5125
5126To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5127the following macro.
5128
5129@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5130If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5131cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5132typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5133@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5134@end defmac
5135
5136The operating system may also require the stack to be made executable
5137before calling the trampoline. To implement this requirement, define
5138the following macro.
5139
5140@defmac ENABLE_EXECUTE_STACK
5141Define this macro if certain operations must be performed before executing
5142code located on the stack. The macro should expand to a series of C
5143file-scope constructs (e.g.@: functions) and provide a unique entry point
5144named @code{__enable_execute_stack}. The target is responsible for
5145emitting calls to the entry point in the code, for example from the
5146@code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT} hook.
5147@end defmac
5148
5149To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5150you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5151cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5152beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5153its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5154
5155@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5156Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5157work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5158which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5159@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5160
5161If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5162C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5163special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5164statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5165global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5166special assembler code.
5167@end defmac
5168
5169@node Library Calls
5170@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5171@cindex library subroutine names
5172@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5173
5174@c prevent bad page break with this line
5175Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5176
5177@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5178This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5179expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5180provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5181are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5182@end defmac
5183
5184@findex set_optab_libfunc
5185@findex init_one_libfunc
5186@hook TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
5187This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5188existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5189@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5190@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5191library routines.
5192
5193The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5194@end deftypefn
5195
5196@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5197This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5198implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5199mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5200return a tristate.
5201
5202GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5203comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5204don't need to define this macro.
5205@end defmac
5206
5207@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5208This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5209functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5210operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5211and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5212If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5213@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5214in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5215@end defmac
5216
38f8b050
JR
5217@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5218@findex matherr
5219@defmac TARGET_EDOM
5220The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5221expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5222deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5223@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5224system.
5225
5226If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5227domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5228error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5229there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5230that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5231@end defmac
5232
5233@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5234@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5235Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5236refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5237@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5238macro, a reasonable default is used.
5239@end defmac
5240
5241@cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5242@defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5243When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5244@code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5245default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5246functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5247systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5248@end defmac
5249
5250@cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5251@defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5252When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5253and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5254default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5255@smallexample
5256void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5257void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5258void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5259@end smallexample
5260@end defmac
5261
5262@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5263Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
5264the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
5265involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
5266at once to the method-lookup library function.
5267
5268The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
5269to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5270@end defmac
5271
5272@node Addressing Modes
5273@section Addressing Modes
5274@cindex addressing modes
5275
5276@c prevent bad page break with this line
5277This is about addressing modes.
5278
5279@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5280@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5281@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5282@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5283A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5284pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5285@end defmac
5286
5287@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5288@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5289A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5290post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5291the size of the memory operand.
5292@end defmac
5293
5294@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5295@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5296A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5297post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5298@end defmac
5299
5300@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5301A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5302is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5303@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5304is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5305constant addresses are supported.
5306@end defmac
5307
5308@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5309@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5310accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5311known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5312expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5313@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5314@end defmac
5315
5316@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5317A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5318memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5319the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5320accept.
5321@end defmac
5322
5323@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
5324A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5325address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5326
5327Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5328non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5329desired by the caller.
5330
5331The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5332that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5333considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5334kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5335must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5336up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5337register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5338if the array holds @code{-1}.
5339
5340The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5341accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5342register is required.
5343
5344Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5345and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5346constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5347specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5348recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5349
5350Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5351sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5352@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5353naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5354be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5355
5356@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5357On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5358the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5359target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5360into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5361@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5362@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5363Format}.
5364
5365@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5366Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5367this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5368has this syntax:
5369
5370@example
5371#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5372@end example
5373
5374@noindent
5375and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5376address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
6f7b223b
PK
5377
5378@findex REG_OK_STRICT
5379Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5380macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5381@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5382that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5383
38f8b050
JR
5384Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5385files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5386@end deftypefn
5387
5388@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5389A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5390character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5391letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5392@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5393support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5394semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5395preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5396@code{'m'} constraint.
5397@end defmac
5398
5399@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5400A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5401or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5402can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5403@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5404
5405It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5406that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5407
5408The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5409a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5410@end defmac
5411
5412@hook TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5413This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5414operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5415address.
5416
5417@findex break_out_memory_refs
5418@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5419and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5420@var{x}.
5421
5422The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5423@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5424should return the new @var{x}.
5425
5426It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5427The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, it
5428is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5429a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5430strategy can generate better code.
5431@end deftypefn
5432
5433@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5434A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5435that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5436@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5437It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5438performance reasons.
5439
5440For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5441reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5442registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5443processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5444needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5445@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5446generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5447be shared.
5448
5449@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5450to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5451and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5452of reload internals.
5453
5454@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5455previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5456then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5457
5458@findex push_reload
5459The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5460need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5461suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5462
5463The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5464@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5465should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5466This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5467@code{push_reload}.
5468
5469@findex strict_memory_address_p
5470The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5471the address has become legitimate.
5472
5473@findex copy_rtx
5474If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5475this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5476single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5477top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5478It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5479address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5480@end defmac
5481
5482@hook TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P
5483This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5484different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5485reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5486but not others.
5487
5488Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5489effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5490of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5491addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5492
5493You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5494
5495The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5496@end deftypefn
5497
5498@defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5499A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5500@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5501different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5502reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5503but not others.
5504
5505Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5506effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5507of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5508addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5509
5510You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5511
5512These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5513@code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5514@end defmac
5515
5516@defmac LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5517A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
5518an immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5519@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this. In fact,
5520@samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
5521anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
5522@end defmac
5523
5524@hook TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5525This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5526@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5527macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5528references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5529addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5530the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5531into their original form.
5532@end deftypefn
5533
5534@hook TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
5535This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5536should not) be spilled to the constant pool. The default version of
5537this hook returns false.
5538
5539The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5540deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5541from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5542holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5543of TLS symbols for various targets.
5544@end deftypefn
5545
5546@hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
5547This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5548be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5549of @var{x}.
5550
5551The default version returns false for all constants.
5552@end deftypefn
5553
89356d17 5554@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL
38f8b050
JR
5555This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5556the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5557@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5558when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5559@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5560of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5561function are valid.
5562@end deftypefn
5563
5564@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD
5565This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5566address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5567used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5568@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5569
5570The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5571@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5572the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5573@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5574two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5575@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5576the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5577from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5578@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5579@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5580@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5581
5582If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5583to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5584use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5585@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5586should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5587described above.
5588If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5589the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5590log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5591@end deftypefn
5592
5593@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN
5594This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5595widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5596
5597If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5598@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5599widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5600preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5601@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5602@end deftypefn
5603
5604@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD
5605This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5606widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5607
5608If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5609@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5610widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5611preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5612@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5613@end deftypefn
5614
5615@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST
5616Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
720f5239
IR
5617For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5618misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
38f8b050
JR
5619@end deftypefn
5620
5621@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE
5622Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5623@end deftypefn
5624
5625@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM
5626Target builtin that implements vector permute.
5627@end deftypefn
5628
5629@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM_OK
5630Return true if a vector created for @code{builtin_vec_perm} is valid.
5631@end deftypefn
5632
5633@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION
5634This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5635input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5636The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5637specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5638(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5639
5640If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5641@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5642conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5643@end deftypefn
5644
5645@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION
5646This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5647vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5648@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5649The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5650return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5651@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5652@end deftypefn
5653
5654@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT
5655This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5656store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5657parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5658the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5659parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5660@end deftypefn
5661
cc4b5170
RG
5662@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE
5663This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5664mode @var{mode}. The default is
5665equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
26983c22
L
5666transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5667@end deftypefn
5668
767f865f
RG
5669@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES
5670This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5671after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5672mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5673The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5674@end deftypefn
5675
38f8b050
JR
5676@node Anchored Addresses
5677@section Anchored Addresses
5678@cindex anchored addresses
5679@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5680
5681GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5682For example, if we have:
5683
5684@smallexample
5685static int a, b, c;
5686int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5687@end smallexample
5688
5689the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5690addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5691it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5692the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5693be something like:
5694
5695@smallexample
5696int foo (void)
5697@{
5698 register int *xr = &x;
5699 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5700@}
5701@end smallexample
5702
5703(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5704``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5705
5706The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5707in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5708section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5709or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5710
5711@hook TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5712The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5713On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5714applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5715for every mode. The default value is 0.
5716@end deftypevr
5717
5718@hook TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5719Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5720offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5721value is 0.
5722@end deftypevr
5723
5724@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR
5725Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5726@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5727The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5728of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5729
5730If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5731it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5732If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5733is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5734@end deftypefn
5735
5736@hook TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P
5737Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5738@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5739@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5740
5741The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5742intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5743or target-specific sections.
5744@end deftypefn
5745
5746@node Condition Code
5747@section Condition Code Status
5748@cindex condition code status
5749
5750The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5751two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5752
5753The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5754(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5755clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5756register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5757architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5758most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5759most RISC machines.
5760
5761The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5762the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5763insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5764optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5765is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5766three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5767scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5768separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5769
5770For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5771represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5772condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5773condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5774or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5775Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5776that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5777
5778Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5779specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5780interested in most macros in this section.
5781
5782@menu
5783* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5784* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
ac7eb5c6 5785* Cond Exec Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
38f8b050
JR
5786@end menu
5787
5788@node CC0 Condition Codes
5789@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5790@findex cc0
5791
5792@findex cc_status
5793The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5794describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5795the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5796variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5797currently based, and several standard flags.
5798
5799Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5800description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5801information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5802
5803@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5804C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5805component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5806
5807This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5808@end defmac
5809
5810@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5811A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5812The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5813the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5814define this macro to initialize it.
5815
5816This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5817@end defmac
5818
5819@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5820A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5821appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5822this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5823code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5824set @code{(cc0)}.
5825
5826This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5827
5828If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5829other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5830invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5831reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5832registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5833@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5834insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5835based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5836value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5837this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5838@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5839@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5840condition code value.
5841
5842The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5843with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5844@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5845constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5846insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5847@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5848@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5849
5850A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5851that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5852@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5853two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5854@end defmac
5855
5856@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5857@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5858@findex CCmode
5859@findex MODE_CC
5860
5861@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5862On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5863than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5864code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5865when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5866bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5867branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5868this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5869record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5870also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5871unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5872
5873If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5874@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5875a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5876have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5877by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5878be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5879the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5880
5881@smallexample
5882(define_insn ""
5883 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5884 (compare:CC_NOOV
5885 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5886 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5887 (const_int 0)))]
5888 ""
5889 "@dots{}")
5890@end smallexample
5891
5892@noindent
5893together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5894for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
5895
5896@smallexample
5897#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5898 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5899 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5900 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5901 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5902 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5903@end smallexample
5904
5905Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5906were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5907this section.
5908
5909You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5910in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
5911@end defmac
5912
5913@defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5914On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5915convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5916does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5917comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5918
5919On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5920required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5921and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5922comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5923@var{op1} as required.
5924
5925GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5926valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5927@file{md} file.
5928
5929You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
5930code or operands.
5931@end defmac
5932
5933@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
5934A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5935comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5936can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5937then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5938
5939You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5940floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5941For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
5942inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5943
5944@smallexample
5945#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5946@end smallexample
5947@end defmac
5948
5949@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
5950A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
5951comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
5952@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
5953machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
5954instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
5955freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
5956like:
5957
5958@smallexample
5959#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
5960 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
5961 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
5962@end smallexample
5963@end defmac
5964
5965@hook TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS
5966On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
5967register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
5968regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
5969hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
5970small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
5971to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
5972arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
5973When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
5974integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
5975@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
5976
5977The default version of this hook returns false.
5978@end deftypefn
5979
5980@hook TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE
5981On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
5982@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
5983validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
5984target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
5985both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
5986return @code{VOIDmode}.
5987
5988The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
5989same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
5990returns @code{VOIDmode}.
5991@end deftypefn
5992
ac7eb5c6 5993@node Cond Exec Macros
38f8b050
JR
5994@subsection Macros to control conditional execution
5995@findex conditional execution
5996@findex predication
5997
5998There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
5999supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6000represent conditional branches.
6001
6002@defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6003A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6004@var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6005versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6006predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
6007that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6008If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6009
6010@smallexample
6011#define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6012 (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6013@end smallexample
6014@end defmac
6015
6016@node Costs
6017@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6018@cindex costs of instructions
6019@cindex relative costs
6020@cindex speed of instructions
6021
6022These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6023on the target machine.
6024
6025@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6026A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6027register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6028expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6029value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6030that.
6031
6032It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6033same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6034registers if they are not general registers.
6035
6036If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6037hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6038classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6039constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6040allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6041if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6042
6043These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6044@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6045@end defmac
6046
6047@hook TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
6048This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6049from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6050are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6051A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6052that.
6053
6054It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6055same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6056registers if they are not general registers.
6057
6058If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6059hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6060classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6061constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6062allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6063if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6064
6065The default version of this function returns 2.
6066@end deftypefn
6067
6068@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6069A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6070register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6071is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6072is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6073registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6074should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6075
6076If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6077the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6078needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6079between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6080more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6081reflect the actual cost of the move.
6082
6083GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6084secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6085a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6086secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
60874 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6088value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6089are the same as to this macro.
6090
6091These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6092@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6093@end defmac
6094
911852ff 6095@hook TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
38f8b050 6096This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
911852ff 6097between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
38f8b050
JR
6098if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6099This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6100If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6101registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6102
6103If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6104the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6105needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
911852ff 6106between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
38f8b050
JR
6107more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6108reflect the actual cost of the move.
6109
6110GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6111secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6112a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6113secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61144 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6115value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6116are the same as to this target hook.
6117@end deftypefn
6118
6119@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
525d13b0
MS
6120A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6121the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6122@var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6123for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6124optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6125true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6126@code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
38f8b050
JR
6127@end defmac
6128
6129Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6130but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6131ordinarily expect.
6132
6133@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6134Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6135than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6136faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6137require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6138between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6139
6140When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6141finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6142load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6143faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6144may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6145other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6146@end defmac
6147
6148@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6149Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6150@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6151than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6152handler.
6153
6154When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6155@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6156moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6157Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6158cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6159
6160If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6161this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6162@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6163@end defmac
6164
6165@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6166The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6167which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6168string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6169make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6170
6171Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6172@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6173the number of such sequences.
6174
6175The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6176optimized for speed rather than size.
6177
6178If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6179@end defmac
6180
6181@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6182A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6183copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6184will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6185than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6186@end defmac
6187
6188@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6189A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6190a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6191@end defmac
6192
6193@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6194The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6195of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6196or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6197eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6198
6199The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6200optimized for speed rather than size.
6201
6202If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6203@end defmac
6204
6205@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6206A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6207to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6208will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6209than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6210@end defmac
6211
6212@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6213The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6214of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6215a block set insn or a library call.
6216Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6217eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6218
6219The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6220optimized for speed rather than size.
6221
6222If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6223@end defmac
6224
6225@defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6226A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6227used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6228other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6229storing values other than constant zero.
6230Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6231than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6232@end defmac
6233
6234@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6235A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6236used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6237other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6238called with a constant source string.
6239Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6240than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6241@end defmac
6242
6243@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6244A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6245thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6246@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6247@end defmac
6248
6249@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6250A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6251thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6252@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6253@end defmac
6254
6255@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6256A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6257thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6258@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6259@end defmac
6260
6261@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6262A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6263thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6264@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6265@end defmac
6266
6267@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6268A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6269thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6270@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6271@end defmac
6272
6273@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6274A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6275thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6276@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6277@end defmac
6278
6279@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6280This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6281thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6282@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6283@end defmac
6284
6285@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6286This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6287thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6288@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6289@end defmac
6290
6291@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6292Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6293function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6294@end defmac
6295
6296@defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6297Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6298@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6299@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6300@end defmac
6301
6302@hook TARGET_RTX_COSTS
6303This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6304
6305The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6306available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
6307in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
6308expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
6309@code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6310
6311In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6312@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6313instructions.
6314
6315On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6316for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6317necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6318for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6319operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6320
6321When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6322false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6323size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6324
6325The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6326processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6327@end deftypefn
6328
6329@hook TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
6330This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6331@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6332the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6333
6334For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6335true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6336instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6337all addresses will have equal costs.
6338
6339In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6340the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6341cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6342
6343For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6344and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6345is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6346references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6347the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6348that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6349instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6350specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6351
6352This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6353
6354On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6355cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6356@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6357be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6358@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6359should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6360should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6361registers on machines with lots of registers.
6362@end deftypefn
6363
6364@node Scheduling
6365@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6366
6367The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6368adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6369hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6370them: try the first ones in this list first.
6371
6372@hook TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
6373This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6374issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6375Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6376an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6377constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6378hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6379This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6380it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6381@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6382@end deftypefn
6383
6384@hook TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
6385This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6386from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6387still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6388@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6389@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6390You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6391than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6392@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6393debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6394@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6395was scheduled.
6396@end deftypefn
6397
6398@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
6399This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6400relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6401dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6402is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6403to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6404that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6405data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6406description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6407output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6408times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6409acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6410@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6411@end deftypefn
6412
6413@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
6414This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6415@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6416execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6417later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6418scheduling priorities of insns.
6419@end deftypefn
6420
6421@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
6422This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6423list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6424combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6425@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6426debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6427@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6428list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6429a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6430reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6431@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6432is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6433the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6434can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6435@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6436@end deftypefn
6437
6438@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2
6439Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6440function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6441is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6442@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6443return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6444this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6445scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6446cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6447@end deftypefn
6448
6449@hook TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK
6450This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6451chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6452correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6453example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6454analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6455dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6456calculated.
6457@end deftypefn
6458
6459@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT
6460This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6461instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6462pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6463is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6464@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6465region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6466scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6467@end deftypefn
6468
6469@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH
6470This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6471instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6472cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6473is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6474to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6475@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6476@end deftypefn
6477
6478@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL
6479This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6480@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6481@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6482@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6483@end deftypefn
6484
6485@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL
6486This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6487@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6488@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6489@end deftypefn
6490
6491@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6492The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6493pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6494when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6495simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6496processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6497based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6498when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6499@end deftypefn
6500
6501@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6502The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6503@end deftypefn
6504
6505@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6506The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6507to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6508simulated processor cycle finishes.
6509@end deftypefn
6510
6511@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6512The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6513used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6514@end deftypefn
6515
6516@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6517The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6518The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6519to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6520state on a single insn is not enough.
6521@end deftypefn
6522
6523@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6524The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6525The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6526to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6527state on a single insn is not enough.
6528@end deftypefn
6529
6530@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
6531This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6532for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6533chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6534value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6535@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6536subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6537maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6538@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6539packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6540rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6541
6542This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6543processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6544with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6545@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6546@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6547processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6548@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6549until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6550the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6551
6552Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6553pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6554schedules to choose the best one.
6555
6556The default is no multipass scheduling.
6557@end deftypefn
6558
6559@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD
6560
6561This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6562considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6563zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6564be issued.
6565
6566The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6567@end deftypefn
6568
894fd6f2
MK
6569@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN
6570This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6571scheduling.
6572@end deftypefn
6573
6574@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE
6575This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6576@end deftypefn
6577
6578@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK
6579This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6580an instruction.
6581@end deftypefn
6582
6583@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END
6584This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6585round of multipass scheduling.
6586@end deftypefn
6587
6588@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT
2b0d3573 6589This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6590@end deftypefn
6591
6592@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI
2b0d3573 6593This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6594@end deftypefn
6595
c06bbdf7 6596@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE
38f8b050
JR
6597This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6598on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6599@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6600the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6601is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6602start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6603verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6604@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6605processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6606and the current processor cycle.
6607@end deftypefn
6608
6609@hook TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE
6610This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6611the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6612are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6613to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6614being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6615dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6616parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6617The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6618insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6619and @code{false} otherwise.
6620
6621Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6622where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6623delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6624that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6625important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6626closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6627not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6628@end deftypefn
6629
6630@hook TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED
6631This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6632the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6633per instruction data structures.
6634@end deftypefn
6635
6636@hook TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT
6637Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6638@end deftypefn
6639
6640@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT
6641Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6642It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6643beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6644@end deftypefn
6645
6646@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT
6647Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6648@end deftypefn
6649
6650@hook TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT
6651Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6652@end deftypefn
6653
6654@hook TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT
6655Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6656@end deftypefn
6657
6658@hook TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN
6659This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6660speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6661The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6662version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6663pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6664or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6665speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6666the generated speculative pattern.
6667@end deftypefn
6668
6669@hook TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P
6670This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6671for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6672instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6673@end deftypefn
6674
6675@hook TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK
6676This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6677check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6678speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6679@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6680be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6681recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6682a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6683@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6684@end deftypefn
6685
6686@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC
6687This hook is used as a workaround for
6688@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6689called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6690discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6691being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6692@var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6693For non-speculative instructions,
6694the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6695the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6696is nearly full.
6697@end deftypefn
6698
6699@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS
6700This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6701enabled/used.
6702The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6703The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6704@end deftypefn
6705
6706@hook TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII
6707This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6708resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6709the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6710backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6711bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6712of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6713@end deftypefn
6714
7942e47e
RY
6715@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH
6716This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6717is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6718@end deftypefn
6719
6720@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO
6721This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6722in its second parameter.
6723@end deftypefn
6724
38f8b050
JR
6725@node Sections
6726@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6727@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6728@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6729
6730An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6731data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6732section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6733section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6734section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6735of sections.
6736
6737@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6738@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6739The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6740is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6741as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6742initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6743They may however depend on command-line flags.
6744
6745@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6746use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6747to be string literals.
6748
6749Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6750section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6751should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6752@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6753
6754You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6755@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6756in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6757@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6758create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6759reuse @code{text_section}.
6760
6761All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6762if the target does not provide them.
6763
6764@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6765A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6766assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6767Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6768@end defmac
6769
6770@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6771If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6772frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6773a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6774@end defmac
6775
6776@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6777If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6778executed functions in the program.
6779@end defmac
6780
6781@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6782A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6783assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6784data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6785@end defmac
6786
6787@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6788If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6789containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6790initialized, writable small data.
6791@end defmac
6792
6793@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6794A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6795assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6796data.
6797@end defmac
6798
6799@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6800If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6801containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
07c5f94e
AS
6802uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
6803@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
38f8b050
JR
6804uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6805@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6806used.
6807@end defmac
6808
6809@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6810If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6811containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6812uninitialized, writable small data.
6813@end defmac
6814
6815@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6816If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6817assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6818common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6819@end defmac
6820
6821@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6822If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6823containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6824default is @code{'T'}.
6825@end defmac
6826
6827@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6828If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6829containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6830initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6831not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6832variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6833@end defmac
6834
6835@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6836If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6837containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6838finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6839not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6840variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6841@end defmac
6842
6843@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6844If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6845containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6846part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6847defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6848both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6849@end defmac
6850
6851@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6852If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6853containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6854part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6855defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6856both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6857@end defmac
6858
6859@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6860If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6861via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6862the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6863@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6864to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6865sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6866ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6867registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6868constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6869@end defmac
6870
6871@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6872If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6873variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6874when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6875you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6876they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6877expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6878MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6879require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6880to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6881access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6882@end defmac
6883
6884@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6885If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6886arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6887@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6888and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6889@end defmac
6890
6891@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6892Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6893tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6894section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6895readonly data section is used.
6896
6897This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6898@end defmac
6899
6900@hook TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS
6901Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6902@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6903of its own that you need to create.
6904
6905GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6906any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6907described below.
6908@end deftypefn
6909
6910@hook TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
6911Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6912selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6913should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6914local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6915
6916The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6917is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
6918when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6919in read-only sections even in executables.
6920@end deftypefn
6921
6922@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION
6923Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
6924assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
6925some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
6926requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
6927local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
6928@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
6929
6930The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
6931variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6932
6933See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
6934@end deftypefn
6935
6936@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
6937Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
6938for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
6939
6940In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
6941function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
6942it is unlikely to be called.
6943@end defmac
6944
6945@hook TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
6946Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
6947and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6948As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
6949the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
6950
6951The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
6952ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
6953example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
6954Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
6955@end deftypefn
6956
6957@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
6958Return the readonly data section associated with
6959@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6960The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
6961the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
6962if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
6963otherwise.
6964@end deftypefn
6965
6966@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
6967Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
6968should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
6969constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
6970case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
6971in bits.
6972
6973The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
6974constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
6975else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6976@end deftypefn
6977
6978@hook TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME
6979Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
6980by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
6981the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
6982or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
6983hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
6984your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
6985returns the @var{id} provided.
6986@end deftypefn
6987
6988@hook TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
6989Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
6990treated differently depending on something about the variable or
6991function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
6992
6993The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
6994@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
6995an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
6996rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
6997in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
6998
6999In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7000a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7001will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7002register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7003rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7004leave it alone.)
7005
7006The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7007that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7008be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7009declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7010declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7011@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7012
7013@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7014The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7015@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7016Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7017encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7018discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7019
7020The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7021in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7022@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7023before overriding it.
7024@end deftypefn
7025
7026@hook TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
7027Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7028the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7029may have added.
7030@end deftypefn
7031
7032@hook TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
7033Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7034The default version of this hook always returns false.
7035@end deftypefn
7036
7037@hook TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7038Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7039``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7040@end deftypevr
7041
3c5273a9
KT
7042@hook TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
7043
38f8b050
JR
7044@hook TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P
7045Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7046rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7047or executable image).
7048
7049The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7050for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7051currently supported object file formats.
7052@end deftypefn
7053
7054@hook TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7055Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7056The default value is false.
7057@end deftypevr
7058
7059
7060@node PIC
7061@section Position Independent Code
7062@cindex position independent code
7063@cindex PIC
7064
7065This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7066independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7067generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7068@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7069@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7070must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7071when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7072need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7073relative addresses.
7074@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7075@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7076
7077@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7078The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7079data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7080processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7081is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7082pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7083is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7084necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7085when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7086@end defmac
7087
7088@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
f8fe0a4a
JM
7089A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7090@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7091the default is zero. Do not define
38f8b050
JR
7092this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7093@end defmac
7094
7095@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7096A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7097operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7098You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7099check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7100check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7101(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7102position independent code.
7103@end defmac
7104
7105@node Assembler Format
7106@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7107
7108This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7109to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7110instructions do.
7111
7112@menu
7113* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7114* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7115* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7116* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7117* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7118 and termination routines.
7119* Macros for Initialization::
7120 Specific macros that control the handling of
7121 initialization and termination routines.
7122* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7123* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7124* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7125* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7126@end menu
7127
7128@node File Framework
7129@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7130@cindex assembler format
7131@cindex output of assembler code
7132
7133@c prevent bad page break with this line
7134This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7135
7136@findex default_file_start
7137@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
7138Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7139find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7140by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7141quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7142@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7143lets other target files rely on these variables.
7144@end deftypefn
7145
7146@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7147If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7148printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7149@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7150to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7151definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7152assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7153whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7154
7155The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7156verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7157comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7158@end deftypevr
7159
7160@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7161If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7162for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7163@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7164this to be done. The default is false.
7165@end deftypevr
7166
7167@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
7168Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7169to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7170@end deftypefn
7171
7172@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7173Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7174special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7175the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7176should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7177need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7178this function.
7179@end deftypefun
7180
7181@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_START
7182Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7183to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7184nothing.
7185@end deftypefn
7186
7187@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_END
7188Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7189to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7190nothing.
7191@end deftypefn
7192
7193@hook TARGET_ASM_CODE_END
7194Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7195unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7196here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7197because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7198nothing.
7199@end deftypefn
7200
7201@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7202A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7203assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7204the end of the line.
7205@end defmac
7206
7207@defmac ASM_APP_ON
7208A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7209statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7210@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7211assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7212that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7213@end defmac
7214
7215@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7216A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7217statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7218@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7219time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7220@end defmac
7221
7222@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7223A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7224which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7225the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7226
7227This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7228for the file format in use is appropriate.
7229@end defmac
7230
b5f5d41d
AS
7231@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7232
38f8b050
JR
7233@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7234A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7235@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7236in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7237the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7238of the filename using this macro.
7239@end defmac
7240
7241@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7242A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7243@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
7244macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7245@end defmac
7246
7247@hook TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
7248Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7249should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7250of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7251is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7252this section is associated.
7253@end deftypefn
7254
f16d3f39
JH
7255@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION
7256Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7257Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7258functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7259at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7260@var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7261(from static destructors).
7262Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7263@end deftypefn
7264
14d11d40
IS
7265@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS
7266
38f8b050
JR
7267@hook TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7268This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
d5fabb58 7269It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
38f8b050
JR
7270@end deftypevr
7271
7272@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7273@hook TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7274This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7275section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7276This is true on most ELF targets.
7277@end deftypevr
7278
7279@hook TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
7280Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7281based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7282declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7283null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7284
7285The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7286read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7287need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7288set via @code{__attribute__}.
7289@end deftypefn
7290
7291@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES
7292Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7293switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7294enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7295It can take the following values:
7296
7297@table @gcctabopt
7298@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7299@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7300
7301@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7302@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7303direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7304default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7305command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7306various different individual optimization passes.
7307
7308@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7309@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7310ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7311target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7312time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7313warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7314wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7315necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7316perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7317switches.
7318
7319@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7320This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7321
7322@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7323This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7324@end table
7325
7326The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7327supported in the future.
7328
7329By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7330provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7331it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7332section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7333provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7334hook.
7335@end deftypefn
7336
7337@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7338This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7339ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7340hook.
7341@end deftypevr
7342
7343@need 2000
7344@node Data Output
7345@subsection Output of Data
7346
7347
7348@hook TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7349@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7350@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7351@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7352@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7353@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7354@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7355@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7356@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7357These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7358of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7359byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7360aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7361@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7362
7363The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7364followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7365the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7366@end deftypevr
7367
7368@hook TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
7369The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7370integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7371in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7372function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7373object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7374split the object into smaller parts.
7375
7376The default implementation of this hook will use the
7377@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7378when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7379@end deftypefn
7380
6cbd8875
AS
7381@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
7382A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7383can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7384the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7385@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7386
7387If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7388so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7389itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7390return @code{true}.
7391@end deftypefn
7392
38f8b050
JR
7393@defmac OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
7394A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
7395@code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
7396@var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
7397allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7398
7399If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
7400@code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
7401prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
7402@code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
7403@end defmac
7404
7405@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7406A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7407instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7408bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7409@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7410
7411If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7412Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7413@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7414@end defmac
7415
7416@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7417A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7418@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7419is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7420@end defmac
7421
7422@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7423You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7424expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7425pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7426GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7427not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7428pool before the function.
7429@end defmac
7430
7431@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7432A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7433constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7434the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7435be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7436is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7437immediately after this call.
7438
7439If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7440not be defined.
7441@end defmac
7442
7443@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7444A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7445constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7446anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7447
7448The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7449assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7450output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7451@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7452@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7453alignment.
7454
7455The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7456the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7457responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7458Here is how to do this:
7459
7460@smallexample
7461@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7462@end smallexample
7463
7464When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7465@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7466entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7467
7468You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7469@end defmac
7470
7471@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7472A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7473pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7474function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7475obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7476constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7477
7478If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7479define this macro.
7480@end defmac
7481
7482@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7483Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7484used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7485to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7486a line separator uses multiple characters.
7487
7488If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7489the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7490@end defmac
7491
7492@hook TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7493These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7494assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7495default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7496@end deftypevr
7497
7498These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7499of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7500
7501@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7502@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7503@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7504@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7505@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7506@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7507These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7508target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7509the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7510@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7511simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7512@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7513by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7514it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
751532 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7516on the host machine.
7517
7518The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7519using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7520machine's memory.
7521@end defmac
7522
7523@node Uninitialized Data
7524@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7525
7526Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7527outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7528
7529@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7530A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7531@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7532@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7533is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7534possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7535other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7536backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7537byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7538equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7539the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7540an ordinary undefined external.
7541
7542Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7543output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7544assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7545
7546This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7547common global variables are output.
7548@end defmac
7549
7550@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7551Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7552separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7553place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7554handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7555as the number of bits.
7556@end defmac
7557
7558@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7559Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7560variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7561is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7562in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7563@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7564the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7565@end defmac
7566
07c5f94e 7567@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
38f8b050
JR
7568A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7569@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
07c5f94e
AS
7570@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7571is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
38f8b050 7572
07c5f94e
AS
7573Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7574@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
38f8b050
JR
7575@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7576before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7577the name, and a newline.
7578
07c5f94e 7579There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
38f8b050
JR
7580The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7581switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7582You do not need to do both.
7583
7584Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7585non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7586efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7587not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7588common in order to save space in the object file.
7589@end defmac
7590
38f8b050
JR
7591@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7592A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7593@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7594@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7595is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7596
7597Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7598output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7599assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7600
7601This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7602static variables are output.
7603@end defmac
7604
7605@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7606Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7607separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7608place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7609handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7610as the number of bits.
7611@end defmac
7612
7613@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7614Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7615variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7616is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7617in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7618@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7619the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7620@end defmac
7621
7622@node Label Output
7623@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7624
7625@c prevent bad page break with this line
7626This is about outputting labels.
7627
7628@findex assemble_name
7629@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7630A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7631@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7632Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7633output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7634assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7635definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7636@end defmac
7637
135a687e
KT
7638@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7639A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7640@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7641a function.
7642Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7643output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7644assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7645definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7646
7647If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7648usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7649@end defmac
7650
38f8b050
JR
7651@findex assemble_name_raw
7652@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7653Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7654to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7655@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7656that it is more efficient.
7657@end defmac
7658
7659@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7660A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7661size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7662default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7663systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7664
7665Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7666of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7667for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7668macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7669define this macro.
7670@end defmac
7671
7672@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7673A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7674@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7675symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7676If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7677provided.
7678@end defmac
7679
7680@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7681A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7682@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7683the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7684address.
7685
7686If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7687provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7688@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7689the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7690not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7691to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7692@end defmac
7693
7694@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7695A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7696type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7697default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7698systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7699
7700Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7701@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7702custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7703types at all, do not define this macro.
7704@end defmac
7705
7706@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7707A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7708the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7709default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7710the default is not to define this macro.
7711
7712Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7713@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7714custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7715types at all, do not define this macro.
7716@end defmac
7717
7718@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7719A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7720@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7721symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7722that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7723you should not count on this.
7724
7725If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7726definition of this macro is provided.
7727@end defmac
7728
7729@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7730A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7731@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7732function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7733outputting the label definition (perhaps using
135a687e 7734@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
38f8b050
JR
7735@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7736
7737If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
135a687e 7738usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
38f8b050
JR
7739
7740You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7741of this macro.
7742@end defmac
7743
7744@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7745A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7746@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7747which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7748function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7749representing the function.
7750
7751If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7752
7753You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7754of this macro.
7755@end defmac
7756
7757@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7758A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7759@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7760initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7761label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7762@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7763
7764If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7765usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7766
7767You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7768@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7769@end defmac
7770
ad78130c 7771@hook TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME
38f8b050
JR
7772A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7773for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7774target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7775@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7776and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7777will be an internal label.
7778
7779The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7780usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7781
7782You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7783@end deftypefn
7784
7785@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7786A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7787@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7788for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7789
7790If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7791nothing.
7792@end defmac
7793
7794@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7795A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7796once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7797chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7798initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7799something about the size of the object.
7800
7801If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7802nothing.
7803
7804You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7805@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7806@end defmac
7807
7808@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
7809This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7810@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7811that is, available for reference from other files.
7812
7813The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7814@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7815@end deftypefn
7816
7817@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME
7818This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7819@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7820global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7821
7822The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7823@end deftypefn
7824
7825@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7826A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7827@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7828that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7829no other definition is available. Use the expression
7830@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7831itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7832for making that name weak, and a newline.
7833
7834If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7835support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7836macro.
7837@end defmac
7838
7839@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7840Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7841@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7842or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7843should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7844defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7845@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7846to make @var{name} weak.
7847@end defmac
7848
7849@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7850Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7851symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7852declaration of @code{name}.
7853@end defmac
7854
7855@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
74b90fe2
JDA
7856A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7857supports weak symbols.
38f8b050
JR
7858
7859If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7860definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
74b90fe2
JDA
7861is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7862@end defmac
7863
7864@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7865A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7866
7867If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7868definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
7869this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7870flag such as @option{-melf}.
38f8b050
JR
7871@end defmac
7872
7873@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7874A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7875public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7876be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7877format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7878section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7879requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7880@end defmac
7881
7882@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7883A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7884semantics.
7885
7886If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7887definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7888definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
7889you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7890setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7891be emitted as one-only.
7892@end defmac
7893
7894@hook TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY
7895This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7896commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7897hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7898@end deftypefn
7899
7900@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7901A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7902that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7903The default is @code{0}.
7904
7905Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7906if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7907will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7908symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7909thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
7910(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
7911with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
7912
7913The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
7914targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
7915restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
7916table of contents.
7917@end defmac
7918
7919@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
7920A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7921@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
7922symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
7923not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
7924declaration.
7925
7926This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
7927The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
7928@end defmac
7929
7930@hook TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
7931This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7932pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
7933library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
7934@end deftypefn
7935
7936@hook TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED
7937This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7938directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
7939.no_dead_code_strip directive.
7940@end deftypefn
7941
7942@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7943A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7944@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
7945@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
7946is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
7947systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
7948@end defmac
7949
77754180
DK
7950@hook TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7951
38f8b050
JR
7952@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
7953A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
7954@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
7955will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
7956to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
7957encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
7958@end defmac
7959
7960@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
7961A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
7962result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
7963@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
7964This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
7965specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
7966when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
7967being taken.
7968@end defmac
7969
7970@hook TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
7971A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
7972name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
7973
7974It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
7975used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
7976will have name conflicts with internal labels.
7977
7978It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
7979object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
7980should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
7981beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
7982convention your system uses, and follow it.
7983
7984The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
7985@end deftypefn
7986
7987@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
7988A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
7989label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
7990@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
7991may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
7992systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
7993bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
7994bundles.
7995
7996If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
7997used.
7998@end defmac
7999
8000@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8001A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8002is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8003
8004This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8005produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8006with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8007
8008If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8009output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8010@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8011string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8012to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8013@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8014you should know what it does on your machine.)
8015@end defmac
8016
8017@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8018A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8019@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8020@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8021added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8022
8023The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8024produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8025@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8026assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8027macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8028internal static variables in different scopes.
8029
8030Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8031conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8032or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8033between the name and the number will suffice.
8034
8035If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8036which is correct for most systems.
8037@end defmac
8038
8039@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8040A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8041which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8042
8043@findex SET_ASM_OP
8044If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8045correct for most systems.
8046@end defmac
8047
8048@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8049A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8050which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8051to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8052be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8053the tree nodes are available.
8054
8055@findex SET_ASM_OP
8056If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8057correct for most systems.
8058@end defmac
8059
8060@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8061A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8062(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8063of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8064current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8065This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8066@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8067@end defmac
8068
8069@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8070A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8071which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8072@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8073an undefined weak symbol.
8074
8075Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8076@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8077@end defmac
8078
8079@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8080Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8081Objective-C methods.
8082
8083The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8084class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8085the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8086@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8087
8088These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8089the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8090systems define other ways of computing names.
8091
8092@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8093buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8094@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
809550 characters extra.
8096
8097The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8098method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8099@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8100in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8101
8102On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8103macro to provide more human-readable names.
8104@end defmac
8105
8106@defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8107A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8108@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8109Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
8110linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8111@end defmac
8112
8113@defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8114A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8115@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8116unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
8117whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8118@end defmac
8119
8120@node Initialization
8121@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8122@cindex initialization routines
8123@cindex termination routines
8124@cindex constructors, output of
8125@cindex destructors, output of
8126
8127The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8128(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8129data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8130to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8131@code{main} is called.
8132
8133Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8134@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8135terminates.
8136
8137To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8138must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8139be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8140system, you need to specify how to do this.
8141
8142There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8143initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8144Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8145
8146@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8147@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8148The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8149initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8150termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8151
8152Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
81530, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8154the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8155pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8156pointer containing zero.
8157
8158Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8159@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8160time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8161list; destructors in forward order.
8162
8163The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8164formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8165aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8166Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8167object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8168the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8169accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8170Termination functions are handled similarly.
8171
8172This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8173@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8174support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8175constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8176and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8177
8178When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8179upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8180support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8181parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8182program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8183
8184@smallexample
8185ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8186@end smallexample
8187
8188The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8189section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8190for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8191files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8192are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8193
8194The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8195compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8196fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8197to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8198of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8199that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8200
8201To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8202macro properly.
8203
8204If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8205@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8206entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8207it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8208after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8209in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8210
8211In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8212two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8213and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8214@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8215entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8216and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8217code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8218the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8219placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8220a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8221@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8222section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8223the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8224the initialization process.
8225
8226The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8227This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8228file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8229this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8230termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8231an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8232pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8233the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8234initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8235via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8236@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8237
8238@ifinfo
8239The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8240customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8241@end ifinfo
8242
8243@node Macros for Initialization
8244@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8245
8246Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8247and termination functions:
8248
8249@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8250If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8251operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8252defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8253using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8254macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8255run the initialization functions.
8256@end defmac
8257
8258@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8259If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8260This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8261on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8262be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8263@end defmac
8264
8265@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8266If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8267the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8268@end defmac
8269
8270@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8271If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8272the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8273@end defmac
8274
8275@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8276If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8277automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8278should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8279the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8280function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8281
8282This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8283shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8284exception tables embedded in the code.
8285@end defmac
8286
8287@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8288If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8289automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8290should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8291the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8292function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8293@end defmac
8294
8295@defmac INVOKE__main
8296If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8297@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8298where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8299useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8300@end defmac
8301
8302@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8303If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8304compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8305of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8306encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8307@end defmac
8308
8309@hook TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8310This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8311collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8312It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8313@end deftypevr
8314
8315@hook TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
8316If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8317the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8318
8319Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8320no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8321priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8322otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8323
8324If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8325be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8326target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8327is not defined.
8328@end deftypefn
8329
8330@hook TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
8331This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8332functions rather than initialization functions.
8333@end deftypefn
8334
8335If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8336generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8337
8338If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8339constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8340an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8341
8342On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8343@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8344
8345@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8346Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8347object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8348object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8349
8350This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8351part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8352@end defmac
8353
8354@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8355Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8356to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8357@command{nm}.
3e794bfe
RO
8358@end defmac
8359
8360@defmac NM_FLAGS
8361@command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8362constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8363passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
2b0d3573 8364are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
3e794bfe
RO
8365produces.
8366@end defmac
38f8b050
JR
8367
8368If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8369dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8370these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8371termination functions in shared libraries:
38f8b050
JR
8372
8373@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8374Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
3e794bfe 8375which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
38f8b050
JR
8376@end defmac
8377
8378@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8379Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8380of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8381of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8382from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8383code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8384line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8385@end defmac
8386
8387@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8388Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8389library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8390strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8391constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8392that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8393@end defmac
8394
8395@node Instruction Output
8396@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8397
8398@c prevent bad page break with this line
8399This describes assembler instruction output.
8400
8401@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8402A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8403registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8404register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8405@end defmac
8406
8407@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8408If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8409and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8410registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8411to registers using alternate names.
8412@end defmac
8413
0c6d290e
RE
8414@defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8415If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8416name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8417machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8418names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8419declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8420@code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8421register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8422
8423This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8424@code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8425register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8426VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8427``s0'' and ``s1''.
8428@end defmac
8429
38f8b050
JR
8430@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8431Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8432requires different names for the machine instructions.
8433
8434The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8435assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8436macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8437points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8438written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8439opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8440increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8441so that it will not be output twice.
8442
8443In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8444name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8445that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8446care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8447@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8448
8449@findex recog_data.operand
8450If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8451elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8452
8453If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8454in the usual way.
8455@end defmac
8456
8457@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8458If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8459assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8460they will be output differently.
8461
8462Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8463extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8464elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8465The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8466template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8467by changing the contents of the vector.
8468
8469This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8470file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8471can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8472as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8473syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8474writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8475
8476If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8477@end defmac
8478
8479@hook TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN
8480If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8481output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8482if necessary.
8483
8484Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8485extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8486elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8487The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8488template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8489by checking the contents of the vector.
8490@end deftypefn
8491
8492@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8493A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8494assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8495RTL expression.
8496
8497@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8498of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8499printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8500the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8501operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8502@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8503@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8504
8505@findex reg_names
8506If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8507The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8508@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8509@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8510
8511When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8512(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8513with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8514@var{code}.
8515@end defmac
8516
8517@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8518A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8519punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8520@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8521punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8522in this way.
8523@end defmac
8524
8525@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8526A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8527assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8528whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8529
8530@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8531On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8532section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8533@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8534@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8535Format}.
8536@end defmac
8537
8538@findex dbr_sequence_length
8539@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8540A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8541been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8542determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8543currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8544or whatever.
8545
8546Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8547reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8548explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8549@end defmac
8550
8551@findex final_sequence
8552Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8553prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8554(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8555found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8556processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8557being output.
8558
8559@findex asm_fprintf
8560@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8561@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8562@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8563@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8564If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8565@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8566@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8567support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8568files can define these macros differently.
8569@end defmac
8570
8571@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8572If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8573statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8574the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8575printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8576statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8577generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8578specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8579The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8580string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8581upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8582@end defmac
8583
8584@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8585If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8586different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8587numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8588first variant.
8589
8590If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8591@smallexample
8592@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8593@end smallexample
8594@noindent
8595in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8596first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8597@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8598@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8599within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8600alternatives within the braces than the value of
8601@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8602
8603If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8604@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8605operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8606
8607Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8608@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8609the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8610@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8611if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8612opcodes or operand order.
8613@end defmac
8614
8615@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8616A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8617which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8618The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8619profiling.
8620@end defmac
8621
8622@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8623A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8624which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8625The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8626profiling.
8627@end defmac
8628
8629@node Dispatch Tables
8630@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8631
8632@c prevent bad page break with this line
8633This concerns dispatch tables.
8634
8635@cindex dispatch table
8636@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8637A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8638pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8639@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8640definitions of these labels are output using
8641@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8642way here. For example,
8643
8644@smallexample
8645fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8646 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8647@end smallexample
8648
8649You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8650dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8651will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8652@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8653mode and flags can be read.
8654@end defmac
8655
8656@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8657This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8658in a dispatch table are absolute.
8659
8660The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8661@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8662a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8663definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8664For example,
8665
8666@smallexample
8667fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8668@end smallexample
8669@end defmac
8670
8671@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8672Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8673specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8674@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8675jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8676@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8677
8678This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8679for the table.
8680
8681If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8682@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8683@end defmac
8684
8685@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8686Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8687jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8688after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8689the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8690@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8691of the preceding label.
8692
8693If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8694the jump-table.
8695@end defmac
8696
8697@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL
8698This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8699should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8700should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8701function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8702The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8703exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8704true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8705
8706The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8707@end deftypefn
8708
8709@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL
8710This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8711It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8712to be broken up according to function.
8713
8714The default is that no label is emitted.
8715@end deftypefn
8716
a68b5e52
RH
8717@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY
8718
38f8b050
JR
8719@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT
8720This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
f0a0390e
RH
8721given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8722returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
38f8b050
JR
8723@end deftypefn
8724
3bc6b3e6
RH
8725@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8726
38f8b050
JR
8727@node Exception Region Output
8728@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8729
8730@c prevent bad page break with this line
8731
8732This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8733region.
8734
8735@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8736If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8737exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8738provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8739@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8740
8741You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8742unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8743@end defmac
8744
8745@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8746If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8747data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8748might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8749collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8750
8751Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8752also defined.
8753@end defmac
8754
8755@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8756Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8757information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8758runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8759and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8760@end defmac
8761
8762@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8763An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8764that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8765@end defmac
8766
8767@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8768Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8769information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8770Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
f0a0390e
RH
8771@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8772or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8773@end defmac
38f8b050 8774
f0a0390e
RH
8775@hook TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO
8776This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8777by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8778should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8779@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8780should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8781information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
38f8b050 8782
f0a0390e
RH
8783A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8784This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8785default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
38f8b050 8786
f0a0390e 8787Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
d5fabb58
JM
8788not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8789@var{opts}. In particular, the
f0a0390e
RH
8790setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8791macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8792depending on this setting.
8793
8794The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8795@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
d5fabb58
JM
8796@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8797@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8798must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
f0a0390e 8799@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8800
8801@hook TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8802This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
d5fabb58
JM
8803tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8804command-line option processing.
38f8b050
JR
8805@end deftypevr
8806
38f8b050
JR
8807@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8808Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8809should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8810instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8811@end defmac
8812
8813@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8814This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8815function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8816@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8817alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8818minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8819the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8820@end defmac
8821
8822@hook TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8823Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8824end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8825Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8826true otherwise.
8827@end deftypevr
8828
8829@hook TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN
8830Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8831represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8832register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8833locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8834register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8835If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8836@end deftypefn
8837
8838@hook TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA
8839If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8840multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8841sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8842It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8843filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8844@var{address} is the address of the table.
8845@end deftypefn
8846
8847@hook TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
8848This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8849the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8850if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8851reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8852@end deftypefn
8853
8854@hook TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8855This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8856based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8857the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8858running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8859@end deftypevr
8860
8861@node Alignment Output
8862@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8863
8864@c prevent bad page break with this line
8865This describes commands for alignment.
8866
8867@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8868The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8869a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8870
8871This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8872to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8873define the macro.
8874
8875Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8876to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8877@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8878selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8879@end defmac
8880
ad0c4c36
DD
8881@hook TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8882The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8883@code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
8884@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8885@end deftypefn
8886
38f8b050
JR
8887@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8888The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8889a @code{BARRIER}.
8890
8891This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8892to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8893define the macro.
8894@end defmac
8895
ad0c4c36
DD
8896@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8897The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
38f8b050
JR
8898@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8899@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
ad0c4c36 8900@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8901
8902@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8903The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8904a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8905
8906This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8907to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8908define the macro.
8909
8910Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8911to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8912@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8913selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8914@end defmac
8915
ad0c4c36
DD
8916@hook TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8917The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
8918@var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
8919defined.
8920@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8921
8922@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
8923The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
8924If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
8925the maximum of the specified values is used.
8926
8927Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8928to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
8929@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8930selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
8931@end defmac
8932
ad0c4c36
DD
8933@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8934The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
8935to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
8936is defined.
8937@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8938
8939@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
8940A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8941instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
8942Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
8943expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8944@end defmac
8945
8946@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
8947Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
8948text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
8949This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
8950produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
8951section.
8952@end defmac
8953
8954@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8955A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8956command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8957@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
8958@end defmac
8959
8960@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8961Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
8962for padding, if necessary.
8963@end defmac
8964
8965@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
8966A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8967command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8968@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
8969satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
8970a C expression of type @code{int}.
8971@end defmac
8972
8973@need 3000
8974@node Debugging Info
8975@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
8976
8977@c prevent bad page break with this line
8978This describes how to specify debugging information.
8979
8980@menu
8981* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
8982* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
8983* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
8984* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
8985* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
8986* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
8987@end menu
8988
8989@node All Debuggers
8990@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
8991
8992@c prevent bad page break with this line
8993These macros affect all debugging formats.
8994
8995@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
8996A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
8997register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
8998of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
8999some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9000versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9001compiler and another for DBX@.
9002
9003If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9004used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9005consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9006Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9007expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9008
9009If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9010does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9011redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9012@end defmac
9013
9014@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9015A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9016variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9017computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9018gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9019that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9020for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9021@option{-g} options is used.
9022@end defmac
9023
9024@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9025A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9026having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9027@var{offset}.
9028@end defmac
9029
9030@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9031A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9032produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9033this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9034debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9035@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9036@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9037
9038When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9039value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9040exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9041value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9042defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9043
9044The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9045user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9046@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9047@end defmac
9048
9049@node DBX Options
9050@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9051
9052@c prevent bad page break with this line
9053These are specific options for DBX output.
9054
9055@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9056Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9057in response to the @option{-g} option.
9058@end defmac
9059
9060@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9061Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9062in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9063@end defmac
9064
9065@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9066Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9067GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9068debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9069macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9070if there is any occasion to.
9071@end defmac
9072
9073@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9074Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9075in the text section.
9076@end defmac
9077
9078@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9079A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9080use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9081If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9082applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9083@end defmac
9084
9085@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9086A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9087use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9088value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9089@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9090information format.
9091@end defmac
9092
9093@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9094A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9095use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9096name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9097macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9098@end defmac
9099
9100@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9101Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9102@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9103describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9104On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9105@end defmac
9106
9107@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9108A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9109continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9110exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9111operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9112must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9113with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9114defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9115@end defmac
9116
9117@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9118Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9119the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9120a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9121constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9122if backslash is correct for your system.
9123@end defmac
9124
9125@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9126Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9127outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9128variable.
9129@end defmac
9130
9131@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9132The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9133for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9134@end defmac
9135
9136@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9137The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9138for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9139provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9140@end defmac
9141
9142@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9143The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9144for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9145``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9146@end defmac
9147
9148@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9149The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9150passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9151do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9152@end defmac
9153
9154@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9155Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9156arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9157in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9158code.
9159@end defmac
9160
9161@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9162Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9163the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9164relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9165an absolute address.
9166@end defmac
9167
9168@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9169Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9170the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9171start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9172@end defmac
9173
9174@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9175Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9176@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9177macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9178number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9179generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9180number for a type number.
9181@end defmac
9182
9183@node DBX Hooks
9184@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9185
9186@c prevent bad page break with this line
9187These are hooks for DBX format.
9188
9189@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9190Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9191information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
9192argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9193@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9194@end defmac
9195
9196@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9197Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9198@end defmac
9199
9200@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9201Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9202output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9203@end defmac
9204
9205@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9206A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9207number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9208@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9209invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9210unique labels in the assembly output.
9211
9212This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9213if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9214@end defmac
9215
9216@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9217Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9218@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9219On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9220disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9221@end defmac
9222
9223@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9224Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9225extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9226feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9227@end defmac
9228
9229@node File Names and DBX
9230@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9231
9232@c prevent bad page break with this line
9233This describes file names in DBX format.
9234
9235@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9236A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9237@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9238file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9239This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9240
9241This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9242for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9243
9244It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9245text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9246to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9247@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9248@end defmac
9249
9250@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9251Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9252of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9253the beginning of the file.
9254@end defmac
9255
9256@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9257Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9258that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9259an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9260@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9261@end defmac
9262
9263@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9264A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9265compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9266written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9267
9268If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9269of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9270@end defmac
9271
9272@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9273Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9274@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9275the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9276whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9277@end defmac
9278
9279@need 2000
9280@node SDB and DWARF
9281@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9282
9283@c prevent bad page break with this line
9284Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9285
9286@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9287Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9288for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9289@end defmac
9290
9291@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9292Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9293debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9294
9295@hook TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION
9296Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9297be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9298value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9299@end deftypefn
9300
9301To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9302define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9303@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9304prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9305as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9306@end defmac
9307
9308@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9309Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
f0a0390e
RH
9310Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9311(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9312exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9313how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
38f8b050
JR
9314@end defmac
9315
f0a0390e
RH
9316@hook TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO
9317This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9318unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9319@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9320return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9321
9322A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9323is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9324
9325A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9326This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9327@end deftypefn
9328
38f8b050
JR
9329@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9330Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9331line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9332tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9333@end defmac
9334
9730bc27
TT
9335@hook TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9336
38f8b050
JR
9337@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9338A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9339@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9340@end defmac
9341
9342@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9343A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9344between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9345slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9346@end defmac
9347
9348@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9349A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9350section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9351given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9352@end defmac
9353
9354@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9355A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9356reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9357@end defmac
9358
9359@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9360A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9361the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9362is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9363is referenced by a function.
9364@end defmac
9365
9366@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
9367If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9368reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9369@end deftypefn
9370
9371@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9372Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9373SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9374macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9375not define them yourself.
9376@end defmac
9377
9378@defmac SDB_DELIM
9379Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9380SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9381delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9382a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9383required.
9384@end defmac
9385
9386@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9387Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9388union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9389allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9390it.
9391@end defmac
9392
9393@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9394Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9395enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9396assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9397@end defmac
9398
9399@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9400A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9401number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9402@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9403@end defmac
9404
9405@need 2000
9406@node VMS Debug
9407@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9408
9409@c prevent bad page break with this line
9410Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9411
9412@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9413Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9414in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9415is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9416@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
fac0f722 9417behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
38f8b050
JR
9418@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9419@end defmac
9420
9421@node Floating Point
9422@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9423@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9424@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9425
9426While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9427there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9428means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9429in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9430doing the compilation.
9431
9432Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9433range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9434the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9435safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9436the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9437emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9438target floating point formats are identical.
9439
9440The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9441use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9442floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9443their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9444
9445@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9446The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9447machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9448array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9449quantity.
9450@end defmac
9451
9452@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9453Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9454floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9455@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9456@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9457@end deftypefn
9458
9459@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9460Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9461@end deftypefn
9462
9463@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9464Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9465@end deftypefn
9466
9467@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9468Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9469@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9470@end deftypefn
9471
9472@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9473Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9474representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9475decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9476defined by the C language for both.
9477@end deftypefn
9478
9479@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9480Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9481@end deftypefn
9482
9483@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9484Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9485@end deftypefn
9486
9487@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9488Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9489@end deftypefn
9490
9491@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9492Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9493@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9494variable).
9495
9496The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9497following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9498@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9499
9500If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9501target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9502@code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9503@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9504@end deftypefn
9505
9506@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9507Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9508@end deftypefn
9509
9510@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9511Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9512@end deftypefn
9513
9514@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9515Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
9516return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9517appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9518precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9519@end deftypefn
9520
9521@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9522Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9523which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9524integral, it is truncated.
9525@end deftypefn
9526
9527@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9528Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9529into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9530value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9531@end deftypefn
9532
9533@node Mode Switching
9534@section Mode Switching Instructions
9535@cindex mode switching
9536The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9537
9538@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9539Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9540switching in an optimizing compilation.
9541
9542For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9543floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9544the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9545operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9546purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9547be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9548or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9549
9550You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9551which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9552return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9553If you define this macro, you also have to define
9554@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9555@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9556@code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9557are optional.
9558@end defmac
9559
9560@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9561If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9562initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9563N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9564of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9565The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9566zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9567entity in question.
9568In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9569represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9570switch is needed / supplied.
9571@end defmac
9572
9573@defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9574@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9575@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9576return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9577@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9578be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9579@end defmac
9580
9581@defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9582If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9583mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9584different from the incoming mode).
9585@end defmac
9586
9587@defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9588If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9589mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9590@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9591is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9592@end defmac
9593
9594@defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9595If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9596mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9597@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9598is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9599@end defmac
9600
9601@defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9602This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
96030 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9604lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9605for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9606(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9607@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9608@end defmac
9609
9610@defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9611Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9612@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9613the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9614@end defmac
9615
9616@node Target Attributes
9617@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9618@cindex target attributes
9619@cindex machine attributes
9620@cindex attributes, target-specific
9621
9622Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9623These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9624be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9625
9626@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9627If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9628attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9629specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9630entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9631take.
9632@end deftypevr
9633
9634@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P
9635If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9636machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9637given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9638subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9639false for all machine-specific attributes.
9640@end deftypefn
9641
9642@hook TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9643If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9644@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9645and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9646generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9647supposed always to be compatible.
9648@end deftypefn
9649
9650@hook TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9651If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9652the newly defined @var{type}.
9653@end deftypefn
9654
9655@hook TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9656Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9657handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9658@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9659that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9660function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9661merging.
9662@end deftypefn
9663
9664@hook TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9665Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9666handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9667@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9668@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9669when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9670attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9671call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9672
9673@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9674If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9675for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9676@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9677will then define a function called
9678@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9679the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9680add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9681to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9682@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9683@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9684@end deftypefn
9685
9686@hook TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P
9687
9688@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9689Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9690@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9691default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9692@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9693of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9694on this implementation detail.
9695@end defmac
9696
9697@hook TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
9698Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9699when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9700wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9701the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9702created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9703for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9704shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9705the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9706attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9707needed.
9708@end deftypefn
9709
9710@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P
9711@cindex inlining
9712This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9713into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9714attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9715target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9716@end deftypefn
9717
9718@hook TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P
9719This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9720it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9721options for the current function that might be different than the
9722options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9723@code{true} if the options are valid.
9724
9725The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9726the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9727@var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9728@end deftypefn
9729
9730@hook TARGET_OPTION_SAVE
9731This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9732in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9733options.
9734@xref{Option file format}.
9735@end deftypefn
9736
9737@hook TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE
9738This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9739information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9740function specific options.
9741@end deftypefn
9742
9743@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRINT
9744This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9745information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9746function specific options.
9747@end deftypefn
9748
56cb42ea 9749@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE
38f8b050
JR
9750This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9751set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9752input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
56cb42ea 9753@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
38f8b050
JR
9754@end deftypefn
9755
9756@hook TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
9757Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9758a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9759@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9760once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9761
9762Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
fac0f722 9763@option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
38f8b050
JR
9764
9765If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9766changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9767@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9768@end deftypefn
9769
9770@hook TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P
9771This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9772cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9773default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9774specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9775@end deftypefn
9776
9777@node Emulated TLS
9778@section Emulating TLS
9779@cindex Emulated TLS
9780
9781For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9782specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9783used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9784configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9785the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9786layer.
9787
9788The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9789object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9790which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9791address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9792
9793@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9794Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9795object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9796emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9797@end deftypevr
9798
9799@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9800Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9801program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9802initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9803have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9804registration function to be used.
9805@end deftypevr
9806
9807@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9808Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9809be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9810any section.
9811@end deftypevr
9812
9813@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9814Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9815placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9816section.
9817@end deftypevr
9818
9819@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9820Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9821The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9822@end deftypevr
9823
9824@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9825Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9826default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9827@end deftypevr
9828
9829@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS
9830Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9831object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9832@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9833@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9834for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9835@end deftypefn
9836
9837@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT
9838Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9839TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9840is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9841initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9842@end deftypefn
9843
9844@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9845Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9846fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9847single objects. The default is false.
9848@end deftypevr
9849
9850@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9851Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9852may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9853@end deftypevr
9854
9855@node MIPS Coprocessors
9856@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9857@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9858
9859The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9860coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
9861accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9862and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9863
9864@smallexample
9865 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9866 unsigned int d;
9867
9868 d = cp0count + 3;
9869@end smallexample
9870
9871(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9872names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9873overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9874
9875Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9876be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9877later in the function.
9878
9879Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9880the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9881floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9882
9883There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9884you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9885
9886@defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9887A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
9888alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
9889@smallexample
9890@{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
9891@end smallexample
9892Default: empty.
9893@end defmac
9894
9895@node PCH Target
9896@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9897@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9898
9899@hook TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY
9900This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9901@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
9902@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
9903@end deftypefn
9904
9905@hook TARGET_PCH_VALID_P
9906This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9907compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
9908if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
9909be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9910
9911@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9912when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9913It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9914compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9915
9916The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9917suitable for most targets.
9918@end deftypefn
9919
9920@hook TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS
9921If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
9922@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
9923of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
9924@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
9925value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
9926@end deftypefn
9927
9928@node C++ ABI
9929@section C++ ABI parameters
9930@cindex parameters, c++ abi
9931
9932@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
9933Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
9934These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
9935default is long_long_integer_type_node.
9936@end deftypefn
9937
9938@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
9939This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
9940@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
9941@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
9942@end deftypefn
9943
9944@hook TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
9945This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
9946whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
9947known that a cookie is needed. The default is
9948@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
9949IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
9950@end deftypefn
9951
9952@hook TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
9953This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
9954array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
9955@end deftypefn
9956
9957@hook TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS
9958If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
9959class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
9960will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
9961to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
9962modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
9963backend's targeted operating system.
9964@end deftypefn
9965
9966@hook TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
9967This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
9968the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
9969@code{false}.
9970@end deftypefn
9971
9972@hook TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
9973This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
9974which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
9975table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
9976Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
9977the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
9978some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
9979method. The default is to return @code{true}.
9980@end deftypefn
9981
9982@hook TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
9983
9984@hook TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
9985This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
9986similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
9987external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
9988classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
9989unit will not be COMDAT.
9990@end deftypefn
9991
9992@hook TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT
9993This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
9994the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
9995be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
9996@end deftypefn
9997
9998@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
9999This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10000should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10001is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10002@end deftypefn
10003
10004@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT
10005This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10006in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10007destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10008shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10009unloaded. The default is to return false.
10010@end deftypefn
10011
10012@hook TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION
10013
10014@node Named Address Spaces
10015@section Adding support for named address spaces
10016@cindex named address spaces
10017
10018The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10019standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10020support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10021processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10022GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10023address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10024spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10025@code{const} type attributes.
10026
10027Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10028pointers to the generic address space.
10029
10030For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10031to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10032processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10033issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10034local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10035address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10036@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10037always 32 bits).
10038
10039Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10040range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10041address space.
10042
10043To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10044the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10045the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10046named address space #1:
10047@smallexample
10048#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10049c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10050@end smallexample
10051
10052@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE
10053Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10054@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10055The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10056generic address space only.
10057@end deftypefn
10058
10059@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE
10060Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10061@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10062The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10063generic address space only.
10064@end deftypefn
10065
10066@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE
10067Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10068with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10069hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10070except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10071version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10072@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10073target hooks for the given address space.
10074@end deftypefn
10075
10076@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
10077Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10078@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10079parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10080finished. This target hook is the same as the
10081@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10082explicit named address space support.
10083@end deftypefn
10084
10085@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
10086Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10087with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10088hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10089except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10090@end deftypefn
10091
10092@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P
10093Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10094contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10095a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10096will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10097arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10098converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10099@end deftypefn
10100
10101@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT
10102Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10103@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10104space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10105to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10106guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10107as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10108@end deftypefn
10109
10110@node Misc
10111@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10112@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10113
10114@c prevent bad page break with this line
10115Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10116
10117@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10118Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10119has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10120conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10121blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10122set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10123to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10124@end defmac
10125
10126@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10127Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10128has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10129conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10130blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10131set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10132to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10133@end defmac
10134
10135@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10136An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10137elements of a jump-table should have.
10138@end defmac
10139
10140@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10141Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10142when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10143it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10144To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10145make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10146The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10147flags can be updated.
10148@end defmac
10149
10150@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10151Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10152should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10153jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10154contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10155is in effect.
10156@end defmac
10157
10158@hook TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
10159This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10160is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10161The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10162five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10163@end deftypefn
10164
10165@defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10166Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10167statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
10168advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10169of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10170targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
10171@code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10172@code{false} otherwise.
10173@end defmac
10174
10175@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10176Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10177smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10178Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10179@end defmac
10180
10181@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10182Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10183memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10184bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10185zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10186of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10187insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10188@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10189
10190This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10191greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10192value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10193@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10194define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10195
10196You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10197the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10198of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10199when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10200integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10201
10202You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10203mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10204@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10205is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10206@end defmac
10207
10208@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10209Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10210extends.
10211@end defmac
10212
10213@defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10214Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10215point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10216unsigned one.
10217@end defmac
10218
10219@hook TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL
10220When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10221divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10222the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10223that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10224of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10225has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10226@end deftypefn
10227
10228@defmac MOVE_MAX
10229The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10230between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10231@end defmac
10232
10233@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10234The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10235between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10236is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10237constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10238at run-time.
10239@end defmac
10240
10241@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10242A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10243actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10244of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10245this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10246a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10247truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10248instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10249include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10250also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10251arguments to bit-field instructions.
10252
10253If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10254position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10255instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10256
10257However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10258only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10259bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10260such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10261the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10262
10263You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10264@end defmac
10265
10266@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10267@hook TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
10268This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10269deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10270@xref{shift patterns}.
10271
10272On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10273shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10274equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10275this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10276otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10277particular behavior is guaranteed.
10278
10279Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10280@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10281that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10282
10283The default implementation of this function returns
10284@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10285and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10286@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10287nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10288by overriding it.
10289@end deftypefn
10290
10291@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10292A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10293``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10294bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10295operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10296
10297On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10298
10299@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10300@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10301When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10302modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10303If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10304such cases may improve things.
10305@end defmac
10306
10307@hook TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED
10308The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10309are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10310@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10311sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10312otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10313representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10314@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10315@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10316@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10317widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10318
10319Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10320value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10321as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10322@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10323
10324Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10325describe two related properties. If you define
10326@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10327to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10328extension.
10329
10330In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10331@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10332@code{mode}.
10333@end deftypefn
10334
10335@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10336A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10337with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10338(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10339apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10340comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10341
10342A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10343comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10344and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10345which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10346true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10347operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10348@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10349@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10350the compiler.
10351
10352If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10353generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10354replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10355the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10356For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10357@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10358@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10359expression
10360
10361@smallexample
10362(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10363@end smallexample
10364
10365@noindent
10366can be converted to
10367
10368@smallexample
10369(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10370@end smallexample
10371
10372@noindent
10373where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10374tested into the sign bit.
10375
10376There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10377for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10378but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10379are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10380perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10381comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10382
10383Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10384from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10385choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10386to be used:
10387
10388@itemize @bullet
10389@item
10390Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10391@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10392``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10393comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10394combine the normalization with other operations.
10395
10396@item
10397For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10398slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10399other machines.
10400
10401@item
10402As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10403exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10404others.
10405
10406@item
10407Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10408@end itemize
10409
10410Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10411@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10412instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10413those cases, e.g., one matching
10414
10415@smallexample
10416(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10417@end smallexample
10418
10419Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10420condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10421@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10422machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10423and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10424@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
2b0d3573 10425@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
38f8b050
JR
10426find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10427
10428If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10429not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10430instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10431@end defmac
10432
10433@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10434A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10435returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10436Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10437floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10438this macro.
10439@end defmac
10440
10441@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10442A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10443for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10444mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10445this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10446return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10447this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10448@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10449the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10450given mode.
10451@end defmac
10452
10453@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10454@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10455A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10456for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10457A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10458If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10459evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10460entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10461the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10462In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10463this value.
10464
10465If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10466@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10467
10468This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10469relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10470is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10471to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10472
10473Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10474and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10475visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10476to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10477breaking the API@.
10478@end defmac
10479
10480@defmac Pmode
10481An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10482this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10483pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10484On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10485modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10486
10487The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10488@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10489@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10490to @code{Pmode}.
10491@end defmac
10492
10493@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10494An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10495being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10496where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10497@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10498size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10499as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10500@end defmac
10501
10502@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10503In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10504constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10505hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10506where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10507strict conformance to the C Standard.
10508
10509Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10510convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10511files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10512@end defmac
10513
10514@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10515Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10516This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10517C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10518@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10519@end defmac
10520
10521@findex #pragma
10522@findex pragma
10523@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10524Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10525If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10526@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10527for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10528setup required for the pragmas.
10529
10530The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10531other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10532definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10533
10534If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10535defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10536
10537Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10538@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10539silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10540@end defmac
10541
10542@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10543@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10544
10545Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10546@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10547@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10548pragma of the form
10549
10550@smallexample
10551#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10552@end smallexample
10553
10554@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10555@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10556routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10557on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10558@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10559callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10560a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10561arguments of pragmas registered with
10562@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10563pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10564
10565Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10566compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10567other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10568to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10569building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10570variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10571target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10572the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10573code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10574rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10575how to build this object file.
10576@end deftypefun
10577
38f8b050 10578@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
24a57808 10579Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
38f8b050
JR
10580arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10581@end defmac
10582
10583@hook TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10584
10585@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10586If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10587the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10588This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10589@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10590@end defmac
10591
10592@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10593Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10594identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10595not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10596there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10597@end defmac
10598
10599@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10600Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10601@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10602G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10603@samp{.} is used instead.
10604@end defmac
10605
10606@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10607Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10608@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10609have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10610are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10611@end defmac
10612
10613@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10614Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10615delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10616even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10617@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10618every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10619or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10620you should define this macro.
10621
10622You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10623@end defmac
10624
10625@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10626Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10627delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10628even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10629@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10630some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10631are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10632define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10633instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10634slot of @var{insn}.
10635
10636You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10637@end defmac
10638
10639@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10640Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10641global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10642symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10643instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10644from shared libraries (DLLs).
10645
10646You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10647@end defmac
10648
10649@hook TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
10650This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10651any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10652It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10653clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10654corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10655clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10656@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10657for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10658@end deftypefn
10659
10660@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10661Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
d9d16a19
JM
10662in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10663@samp{""} if the target does not have a
38f8b050
JR
10664separate math library.
10665
d9d16a19 10666You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
38f8b050
JR
10667@end defmac
10668
10669@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10670Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10671specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10672
10673You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10674is wrong.
10675@end defmac
10676
10677@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10678Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10679functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10680Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10681to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10682if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10683for cross-profiling.
10684@end defmac
10685
10686@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10687
10688A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10689conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10690@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
106911 if it does use cc0.
10692@end defmac
10693
10694@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10695Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10696conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10697@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10698contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10699and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10700then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10701@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10702@end defmac
10703
10704@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10705Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10706if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10707@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10708being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10709@end defmac
10710
10711@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10712A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10713be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10714a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10715about the currently processed blocks.
10716@end defmac
10717
10718@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10719A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10720converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10721can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10722to by @var{ce_info}.
10723@end defmac
10724
10725@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10726A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10727converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10728can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10729to by @var{ce_info}.
10730@end defmac
10731
10732@defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10733A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10734structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10735@end defmac
10736
10737@defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10738If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10739added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
10740by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10741@end defmac
10742
10743@hook TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
10744If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10745instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10746just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10747
10748The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10749it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10750laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10751Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10752
10753You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10754definition is null.
10755@end deftypefn
10756
10757@hook TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
10758Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10759that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10760necessary setup.
10761
10762Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10763instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10764they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10765instructions or prefetch instructions).
10766
10767To create a built-in function, call the function
10768@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10769which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10770up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
10771only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10772@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10773@end deftypefn
10774
10775@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
10776Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10777that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10778builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10779If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10780if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10781If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10782@code{error_mark_node}.
10783@end deftypefn
10784
10785@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
10786
10787Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10788@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10789function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10790convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10791@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10792@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10793ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10794built-in function.
10795@end deftypefn
10796
d66f5459 10797@hook TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10798Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10799was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10800@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10801implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10802declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10803arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10804complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10805another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10806@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10807@end deftypefn
10808
08914aaa 10809@hook TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10810Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10811@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10812built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10813the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10814The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10815call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10816@end deftypefn
10817
10818@hook TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP
10819
10820Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10821low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10822could not be applied.
10823
10824Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10825instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10826the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10827By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10828loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10829@end deftypefn
10830
10831@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10832
10833Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10834Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10835@var{branch2} is possible.
10836
10837On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10838filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10839may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10840@end defmac
10841
10842@hook TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
10843This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10844Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10845PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10846of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10847@end deftypefn
10848
10849@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
10850
10851When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10852register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10853to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10854it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10855is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10856that had its initial value copied by using
10857@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10858Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10859to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10860the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10861@code{MEM}.
10862If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10863it might decide to use another register anyways.
10864You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10865that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10866register in question will not be clobbered.
10867The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10868allocation.
10869@end deftypefn
10870
10871@hook TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P
10872This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10873@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10874this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10875@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10876to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10877passed along.
10878@end deftypefn
10879
10880@hook TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION
10881The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
10882context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10883the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10884per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10885attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10886The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10887and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10888and is returning to processing at the top level.
10889The default hook function does nothing.
10890
10891GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10892some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10893situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
10894or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
10895@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
10896outside of any function scope.
10897@end deftypefn
10898
10899@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
10900Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
10901files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
10902use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
10903@end defmac
10904
10905@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
10906Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
10907automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
10908do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
10909executable files.
10910@end defmac
10911
10912@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
10913If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
10914specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
10915Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
10916object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
10917lists.
10918@end defmac
10919
10920@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
10921Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
10922method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
10923must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
10924For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
10925the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
10926defined as this expression:
10927
10928@smallexample
10929build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
10930 build_tree_list
10931 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
10932 NULL))
10933@end smallexample
10934@end defmac
10935
10936@hook TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P
10937This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
10938instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
10939every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
10940reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
10941
10942@smallexample
10943static bool
10944cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
10945@{
10946 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
10947@}
10948@end smallexample
10949@end deftypefn
10950
10951@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS
10952This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
10953optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
10954usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
10955re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
10956to inter-block scheduling.
10957@end deftypefn
10958
10959@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED
10960Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
10961registers
10962that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
10963returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
10964that all target registers in the class returned by
10965@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
10966saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
10967epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
10968true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
10969to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
10970to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
10971@end deftypefn
10972
10973@hook TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION
10974This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
10975This target hook is required only when the target has several different
10976modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
10977@end deftypefn
10978
10979@hook TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST
10980This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
10981should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
10982the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
10983the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
10984is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
10985number of memory accesses.
10986@end deftypefn
10987
10988@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
10989If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
10990that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
10991that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
10992constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
10993more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
10994system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
10995The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
10996@end defmac
10997
10998@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
10999This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11000target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11001are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11002The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11003@end deftypefn
11004
11005@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11006This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11007target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11008indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11009@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11010@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11011@end deftypefn
11012
11013@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11014This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11015The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11016systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11017that are different from @option{-I}.
11018@end deftypefn
11019
11020@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11021This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11022for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11023@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11024functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11025@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11026@end defmac
11027
11028@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11029If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11030target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11031option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11032@end defmac
11033
11034@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11035If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11036@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11037@end defmac
11038
11039@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11040If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11041target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11042default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11043@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11044@end defmac
11045
11046@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11047If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11048@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11049@end defmac
11050
11051@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11052If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11053routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11054and scanf formatter settings.
11055@end defmac
11056
11057@hook TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11058If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11059guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11060main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11061important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11062many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11063``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11064and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11065@end deftypevr
11066
11067@hook TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN
11068If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11069illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11070with prototype @var{typelist}.
11071@end deftypefn
11072
11073@hook TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION
11074If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11075invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11076if validity should be determined by the front end.
11077@end deftypefn
11078
11079@hook TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP
11080If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11081invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11082@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11083if validity should be determined by the front end.
11084@end deftypefn
11085
11086@hook TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP
11087If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11088invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11089and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11090the front end.
11091@end deftypefn
11092
11093@hook TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE
11094If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11095invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11096or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11097the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11098@end deftypefn
11099
11100@hook TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE
11101If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11102invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11103or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11104the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11105@end deftypefn
11106
11107@hook TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE
11108If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11109@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11110analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11111front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11112target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11113This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11114@end deftypefn
11115
11116@hook TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE
11117If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11118@var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11119or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11120This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11121conversion rules.
11122This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11123@end deftypefn
11124
11125@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11126This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11127classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11128SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11129@end defmac
11130
11131@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11132This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11133NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11134@end defmac
11135
11136@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11137Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11138to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11139call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11140and the associated definitions of those functions.
11141@end defmac
11142
11143@hook TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY
11144Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11145necessary.
11146@end deftypefn
11147
11148@hook TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX
11149This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11150different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11151argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11152is needed.
11153@end deftypefn
11154
11155@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS
11156When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11157arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11158stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11159debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11160@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11161cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11162to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11163false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11164@end deftypefn
11165
11166@hook TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11167On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11168a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11169is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11170is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11171subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11172the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11173available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11174constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11175down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11176@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11177accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11178value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11179MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11180@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11181is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr
This page took 1.422657 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.